Merge changes made in Gnus trunk
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob4b34d6344ac3eaf394906036ee88ed3ed26a0e75
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
50 #include "systime.h"
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
88 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
89 #include <sys/time.h>
90 #endif
92 #include <unistd.h>
94 #ifdef USE_GTK
95 #include "gtkutil.h"
96 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
97 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
98 #endif
99 #endif
101 #ifdef USE_LUCID
102 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
103 #endif
105 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
106 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
107 #define HACK_EDITRES
108 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
109 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
111 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
113 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
114 #if defined USE_MOTIF
115 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
116 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
117 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
119 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
120 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
121 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
123 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
124 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
125 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
126 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
127 #ifndef XtNpickTop
128 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
129 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
130 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
131 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
133 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
135 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
136 #include "widget.h"
137 #ifndef XtNinitialState
138 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
139 #endif
140 #endif
142 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
143 #ifdef USE_XIM
144 int use_xim = 1;
145 #else
146 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
147 #endif
151 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
152 start. */
154 static int any_help_event_p;
156 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
157 static Lisp_Object last_window;
159 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
160 use. */
162 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
164 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
165 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
166 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
167 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
169 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
171 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
172 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
173 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
174 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
176 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
178 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
180 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
182 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
184 static struct {
185 struct frame *f;
186 int eventtype;
187 } pending_event_wait;
189 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
190 /* The application context for Xt use. */
191 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
192 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
194 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
196 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
197 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
199 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
200 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
201 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
203 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
205 /* Mouse movement.
207 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
208 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
209 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
210 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
212 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
214 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
215 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
216 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
217 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
218 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
219 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
220 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
221 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
222 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
223 is off. */
225 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
227 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
228 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
229 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
231 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
233 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
234 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
235 an ordinary motion.
237 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
238 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
239 event. */
241 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
243 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
244 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
245 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
246 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
247 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
248 it's somewhat accurate. */
250 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
252 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
254 static Time last_user_time;
256 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
257 events. */
259 #ifdef __STDC__
260 static int volatile input_signal_count;
261 #else
262 static int input_signal_count;
263 #endif
265 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
267 static int x_noop_count;
269 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
271 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
272 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
274 #ifdef USE_GTK
275 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
276 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
278 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
279 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
280 #endif
282 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
283 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
285 enum xembed_info
287 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
290 enum xembed_message
292 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
293 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
294 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
295 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
296 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
297 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
298 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
299 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
301 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
302 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
303 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
304 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
305 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
308 /* Used in x_flush. */
310 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
311 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
312 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
313 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
314 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
315 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
317 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
318 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
319 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
320 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
321 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
322 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
323 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
324 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
325 static void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int) NO_RETURN;
326 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
327 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
328 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
329 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
330 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
331 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
332 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
333 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
334 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
335 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
336 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
337 enum text_cursor_kinds);
339 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
340 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
341 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
342 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
343 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
344 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
345 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
346 enum scroll_bar_part *,
347 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
348 Time *);
349 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
350 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
351 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
352 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
353 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
354 int *, struct input_event *);
355 #ifdef USE_GTK
356 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
357 #endif
358 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
359 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
360 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
361 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
362 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
363 static void x_initialize (void);
366 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
368 static void
369 x_flush (struct frame *f)
371 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
372 connection may be broken. */
373 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
374 return;
376 BLOCK_INPUT;
377 if (f == NULL)
379 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
380 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
381 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
382 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
384 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
385 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
386 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
390 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
391 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
392 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
393 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
394 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
395 performance. */
397 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
400 /***********************************************************************
401 Debugging
402 ***********************************************************************/
404 #if 0
406 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
407 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
409 struct record
411 char *locus;
412 int type;
415 struct record event_record[100];
417 int event_record_index;
419 void
420 record_event (char *locus, int type)
422 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
423 event_record_index = 0;
425 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
426 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
427 event_record_index++;
430 #endif /* 0 */
434 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
436 struct x_display_info *
437 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
439 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
441 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
442 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
443 return dpyinfo;
445 return 0;
448 static Window
449 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
451 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
452 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
453 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
455 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
457 Window root;
458 Window *children;
459 unsigned int nchildren;
461 win = wi;
462 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
463 XFree (children);
466 return win;
469 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
471 void
472 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
474 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
475 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
476 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
477 double alpha = 1.0;
478 double alpha_min = 1.0;
479 unsigned long opac;
480 Window parent;
482 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
483 alpha = f->alpha[0];
484 else
485 alpha = f->alpha[1];
487 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
488 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
489 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
490 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
492 if (alpha < 0.0)
493 return;
494 else if (alpha > 1.0)
495 alpha = 1.0;
496 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
497 alpha = alpha_min;
499 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
501 x_catch_errors (dpy);
503 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
504 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
505 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
506 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
508 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
509 if (parent != None)
510 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
511 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
512 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
514 /* return unless necessary */
516 unsigned char *data;
517 Atom actual;
518 int rc, format;
519 unsigned long n, left;
521 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
522 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
523 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
524 &data);
526 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
528 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
529 XFree ((void *) data);
530 if (value == opac)
532 x_uncatch_errors ();
533 return;
538 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
539 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
540 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
541 x_uncatch_errors ();
545 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
547 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
551 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
553 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
557 /***********************************************************************
558 Starting and ending an update
559 ***********************************************************************/
561 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
562 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
563 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
564 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
565 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
567 static void
568 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
570 /* Nothing to do. */
574 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
575 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
576 position of W. */
578 static void
579 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
581 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
582 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
584 updated_window = w;
585 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
587 BLOCK_INPUT;
589 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
591 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
592 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
594 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
595 highlighting. */
596 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
597 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
600 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
604 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
606 static void
607 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
609 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
610 struct face *face;
612 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
613 if (face)
614 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
615 face->foreground);
617 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
618 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
621 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
623 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
624 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
626 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
627 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
628 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
630 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
631 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
632 here. */
634 static void
635 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
637 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
639 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
641 BLOCK_INPUT;
643 if (cursor_on_p)
644 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
645 output_cursor.vpos,
646 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
648 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
649 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
651 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
654 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
655 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
656 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
658 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
659 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
660 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
663 updated_window = NULL;
667 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
668 update_end. */
670 static void
671 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
673 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
674 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
676 #ifndef XFlush
677 BLOCK_INPUT;
678 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
679 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
680 #endif
684 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
685 complete update has been performed. The global variable
686 updated_window is not available here. */
688 static void
689 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
691 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
693 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
695 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
696 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
698 BLOCK_INPUT;
699 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
700 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
701 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
702 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
703 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
704 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
710 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
711 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
712 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
713 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
714 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
715 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
717 static void
718 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
720 struct window *w = updated_window;
721 struct frame *f;
722 int width, height;
724 xassert (w);
726 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
727 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
729 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
730 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
731 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
732 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
733 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
734 overhead is very small. */
735 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
736 && desired_row->full_width_p
737 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
738 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
739 width != 0)
740 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
741 height > 0))
743 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
745 BLOCK_INPUT;
746 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
747 0, y, width, height, False);
748 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
749 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
750 y, width, height, False);
751 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
755 static void
756 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
758 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
759 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
760 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
761 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
762 struct face *face = p->face;
764 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
765 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
767 if (!p->overlay_p)
769 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
771 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
772 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
773 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
774 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
775 if (face->stipple)
776 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
777 else
778 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
780 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
781 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
782 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
783 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
784 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
785 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
786 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
787 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
789 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
791 if (sb_width > 0)
793 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
794 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
795 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
797 if (bx < 0)
799 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
800 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
801 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
802 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
803 bx = bar_area_x;
804 if (bx >= 0)
806 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
808 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
809 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
810 row->y));
811 ny = row->visible_height;
814 else
816 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
818 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
819 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
821 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
822 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
826 #endif
827 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
828 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
830 if (!face->stipple)
831 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
834 if (p->which)
836 char *bits;
837 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
838 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
839 XGCValues gcv;
841 if (p->wd > 8)
842 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
843 else
844 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
846 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
847 by the server. */
848 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
849 (p->cursor_p
850 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
851 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
852 : face->foreground),
853 face->background, depth);
855 if (p->overlay_p)
857 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
858 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
859 bits, p->wd, p->h,
860 1, 0, 1);
861 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
862 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
863 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
864 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
867 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
868 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
869 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
871 if (p->overlay_p)
873 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
874 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
875 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
879 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
884 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
885 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
886 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
887 rarely happens). */
889 static void
890 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
894 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
895 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
897 static void
898 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
903 /***********************************************************************
904 Glyph display
905 ***********************************************************************/
909 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
910 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
911 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
912 int);
913 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
914 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
915 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
916 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
917 static void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int) NO_RETURN;
918 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
919 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
920 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
921 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
922 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
923 unsigned long *, double, int);
924 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
925 double, int, unsigned long);
926 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
927 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
928 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
929 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
930 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
931 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
932 int, int, int);
933 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
934 int, int, int, int, int, int,
935 XRectangle *);
936 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
937 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
938 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
940 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
941 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
942 #endif
945 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
946 face. */
948 static void
949 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
951 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
952 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
953 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
954 && !s->cmp)
955 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
956 else
958 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
959 XGCValues xgcv;
960 unsigned long mask;
962 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
963 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
965 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
966 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
967 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
968 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
969 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
970 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
971 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
973 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
974 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
975 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
977 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
978 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
981 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
982 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
983 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
985 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
986 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
987 mask, &xgcv);
988 else
989 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
990 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
992 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
997 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
999 static void
1000 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1002 int face_id;
1003 struct face *face;
1005 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1006 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1007 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1008 if (face == NULL)
1009 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1011 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1012 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1013 else
1014 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1015 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1016 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1018 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1019 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1020 else
1022 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1023 except for FONT. */
1024 XGCValues xgcv;
1025 unsigned long mask;
1027 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1028 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1029 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1030 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1032 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1033 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1034 mask, &xgcv);
1035 else
1036 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1037 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1039 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1042 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1046 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1047 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1048 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1050 static inline void
1051 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1053 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1057 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1058 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1059 pattern. */
1061 static inline void
1062 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1064 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1066 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1068 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1069 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1071 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1073 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1074 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1076 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1078 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1079 s->stippled_p = 0;
1081 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1083 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1084 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1086 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1087 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1089 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1090 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1092 else
1094 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1095 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1098 /* GC must have been set. */
1099 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1103 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1104 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1106 static inline void
1107 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1109 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1110 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1112 if (n > 0)
1113 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1114 s->num_clips = n;
1118 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1119 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1120 the area of SRC. */
1122 static void
1123 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1125 XRectangle r;
1127 r.x = src->x;
1128 r.width = src->width;
1129 r.y = src->y;
1130 r.height = src->height;
1131 dst->clip[0] = r;
1132 dst->num_clips = 1;
1133 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1137 /* RIF:
1138 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1140 static void
1141 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1143 if (s->cmp == NULL
1144 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1145 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1147 struct font_metrics metrics;
1149 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1151 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1152 struct font *font = s->font;
1153 int i;
1155 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1156 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1157 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1159 else
1161 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1163 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1165 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1166 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1167 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1169 else if (s->cmp)
1171 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1172 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1177 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1179 static inline void
1180 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1182 XGCValues xgcv;
1183 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1184 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1185 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1186 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1190 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1191 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1192 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1193 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1194 contains the first component of a composition. */
1196 static void
1197 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1199 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1200 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1201 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1203 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1205 if (s->stippled_p)
1207 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1208 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1209 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1210 s->y + box_line_width,
1211 s->background_width,
1212 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1213 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1214 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1216 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1217 || s->font_not_found_p
1218 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1219 || force_p)
1221 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1222 s->background_width,
1223 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1224 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1230 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1232 static void
1233 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1235 int i, x;
1237 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1238 of S to the right of that box line. */
1239 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1240 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1241 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1242 else
1243 x = s->x;
1245 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1246 loaded. */
1247 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1249 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1251 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1252 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1253 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1254 s->height - 1);
1255 x += g->pixel_width;
1258 else
1260 struct font *font = s->font;
1261 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1262 int y;
1264 if (font->vertical_centering)
1265 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1267 y = s->ybase - boff;
1268 if (s->for_overlaps
1269 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1270 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1271 else
1272 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1273 if (s->face->overstrike)
1274 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1278 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1280 static void
1281 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1283 int i, j, x;
1284 struct font *font = s->font;
1286 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1287 of S to the right of that box line. */
1288 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1289 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1290 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1291 else
1292 x = s->x;
1294 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1295 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1296 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1297 this composition. */
1299 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1300 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1301 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1303 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1304 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1305 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1307 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1309 int y = s->ybase;
1311 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1312 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1313 space on the left or right. */
1314 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1316 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1317 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1319 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1320 if (s->face->overstrike)
1321 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1324 else
1326 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1327 Lisp_Object glyph;
1328 int y = s->ybase;
1329 int width = 0;
1331 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1333 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1334 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1335 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1336 else
1338 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1340 if (j < i)
1342 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1343 if (s->face->overstrike)
1344 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1345 x += width;
1347 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1348 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1349 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1350 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1351 if (s->face->overstrike)
1352 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1353 x += wadjust;
1354 j = i + 1;
1355 width = 0;
1358 if (j < i)
1360 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1361 if (s->face->overstrike)
1362 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1368 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1370 static void
1371 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1373 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1374 XChar2b char2b[8];
1375 int x, i, j;
1377 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1378 of S to the right of that box line. */
1379 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1380 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1381 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1382 else
1383 x = s->x;
1385 s->char2b = char2b;
1387 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1389 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1390 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1392 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1394 if (len > 0
1395 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1396 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1397 >= 1))
1399 Lisp_Object acronym
1400 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1401 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1402 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1403 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1404 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1405 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1408 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1410 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1411 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1412 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1413 str = buf;
1416 if (str)
1418 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1419 unsigned code;
1421 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1422 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1424 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1425 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1427 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1428 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1429 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1431 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1432 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1433 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1436 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1437 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1438 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1439 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1440 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1441 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1445 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1447 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1448 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1449 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1450 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1451 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1454 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1455 cannot be determined. */
1457 static struct frame *
1458 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1460 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1461 Lisp_Object tail;
1462 struct frame *f;
1464 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1466 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1467 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1468 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1469 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1470 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1471 widget = XtParent (widget);
1473 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1474 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1475 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1476 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1477 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1478 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1479 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1480 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1481 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1482 return f;
1484 abort ();
1488 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1490 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1491 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1492 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1493 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1494 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1495 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1498 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1499 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1501 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1502 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1505 #endif
1508 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1509 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1511 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1513 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1514 sizeof (Screen *)},
1515 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1516 sizeof (Colormap)}
1520 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1521 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1523 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1526 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1528 DPY is the display we are working on.
1530 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1531 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1532 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1533 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1535 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1536 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1538 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1539 we allocated the color or not.
1541 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1543 static Boolean
1544 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1545 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1546 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1548 Screen *screen;
1549 Colormap cmap;
1550 Pixel pixel;
1551 String color_name;
1552 XColor color;
1554 if (*nargs != 2)
1556 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1557 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1558 "XtToolkitError",
1559 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1560 return False;
1563 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1564 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1565 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1567 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1569 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1570 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1572 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1574 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1575 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1577 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1578 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1580 pixel = color.pixel;
1581 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1583 else
1585 String params[1];
1586 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1588 params[0] = color_name;
1589 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1590 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1591 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1592 params, &nparams);
1593 return False;
1596 if (to->addr != NULL)
1598 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1600 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1601 return False;
1604 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1606 else
1608 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1609 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1612 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1613 return True;
1617 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1618 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1619 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1621 APP is the application context in which we work.
1623 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1624 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1625 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1627 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1629 static void
1630 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1631 Cardinal *nargs)
1633 if (*nargs != 2)
1635 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1636 "XtToolkitError",
1637 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1638 NULL, NULL);
1640 else if (closure != NULL)
1642 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1643 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1644 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1645 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1646 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1651 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1654 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1655 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1656 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1657 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1659 static const XColor *
1660 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1662 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1664 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1666 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1667 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1668 int i;
1670 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1671 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1672 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1674 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1675 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1677 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1678 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1681 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1682 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1686 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1687 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1689 void
1690 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1692 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1694 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1696 int i;
1697 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1699 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1700 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1701 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1702 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1705 else
1706 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1710 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1711 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1713 void
1714 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1716 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1720 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1721 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1722 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1723 allocated. */
1725 static int
1726 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1728 int rc;
1730 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1731 if (rc == 0)
1733 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1734 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1735 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1736 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1737 int nearest, i;
1738 int max_color_delta = 255;
1739 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1740 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1741 int ncells;
1742 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1744 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1746 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1747 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1748 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1749 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1751 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1753 nearest = i;
1754 nearest_delta = delta;
1758 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1759 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1760 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1761 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1763 else
1765 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1766 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1767 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1768 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1769 XColor *cached_color;
1771 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1772 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1773 (cached_color->red != color->red
1774 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1775 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1777 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1778 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1779 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1783 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1784 if (rc)
1785 register_color (color->pixel);
1786 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1788 return rc;
1792 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1793 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1794 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1795 allocated. */
1798 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1800 gamma_correct (f, color);
1801 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1805 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1806 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1807 get color reference counts right. */
1809 unsigned long
1810 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1812 XColor color;
1814 color.pixel = pixel;
1815 BLOCK_INPUT;
1816 x_query_color (f, &color);
1817 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1818 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1819 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1820 register_color (pixel);
1821 #endif
1822 return color.pixel;
1826 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1827 boosted.
1829 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1830 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1831 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1832 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1833 use an additional additive factor.
1835 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1836 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1837 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1840 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1841 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1842 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1843 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1844 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1845 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1847 static int
1848 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1850 XColor color, new;
1851 long bright;
1852 int success_p;
1854 /* Get RGB color values. */
1855 color.pixel = *pixel;
1856 x_query_color (f, &color);
1858 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1859 xassert (factor >= 0);
1860 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1861 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1862 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1864 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1865 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1867 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1868 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1869 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1870 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1871 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1873 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1874 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1875 /* The additive adjustment. */
1876 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1878 if (factor < 1)
1880 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1881 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1882 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1884 else
1886 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1887 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1888 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1892 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1893 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1894 if (success_p)
1896 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1898 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1899 delta to the RGB values. */
1900 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1902 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1903 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1904 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1905 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1907 else
1908 success_p = 1;
1909 *pixel = new.pixel;
1912 return success_p;
1916 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1917 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1918 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1919 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1920 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1921 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1923 static void
1924 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1926 XGCValues xgcv;
1927 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1928 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1929 unsigned long pixel;
1930 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1931 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1932 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1933 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1935 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1936 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1938 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1939 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1940 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1941 if (relief->gc
1942 && relief->allocated_p)
1944 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1945 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1948 /* Allocate new color. */
1949 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1950 pixel = background;
1951 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1952 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1954 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1955 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1958 if (relief->gc == 0)
1960 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1961 mask |= GCStipple;
1962 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1964 else
1965 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1969 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1971 static void
1972 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1974 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1975 unsigned long color;
1977 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1978 color = s->face->box_color;
1979 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1980 && s->img->pixmap
1981 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1982 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1983 else
1985 XGCValues xgcv;
1987 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1988 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1989 color = xgcv.background;
1992 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1993 || color != di->relief_background)
1995 di->relief_background = color;
1996 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1997 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1998 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1999 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2004 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2005 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2006 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2007 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2008 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2009 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2010 when drawing. */
2012 static void
2013 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2014 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2015 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
2016 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2018 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2019 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2020 int i;
2021 GC gc;
2023 if (raised_p)
2024 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2025 else
2026 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2027 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2029 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2030 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2031 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2032 corner pixels. */
2034 /* Top. */
2035 if (top_p)
2037 if (width == 1)
2038 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2039 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2040 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2042 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2043 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2044 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2045 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2048 /* Left. */
2049 if (left_p)
2051 if (width == 1)
2052 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2054 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2055 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2057 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2058 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2059 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2062 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2063 if (raised_p)
2064 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2065 else
2066 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2067 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2069 if (width > 1)
2071 /* Outermost top line. */
2072 if (top_p)
2073 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2074 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2075 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2077 /* Outermost left line. */
2078 if (left_p)
2079 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2082 /* Bottom. */
2083 if (bot_p)
2085 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2086 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2087 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2088 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2089 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2090 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2091 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2094 /* Right. */
2095 if (right_p)
2097 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2098 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2099 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2100 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2101 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2104 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2108 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2109 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2110 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2111 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2112 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2113 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2115 static void
2116 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2117 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2118 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2120 XGCValues xgcv;
2122 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2123 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2124 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2126 /* Top. */
2127 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2128 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2130 /* Left. */
2131 if (left_p)
2132 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2133 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2135 /* Bottom. */
2136 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2137 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2139 /* Right. */
2140 if (right_p)
2141 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2142 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2144 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2145 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2149 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2151 static void
2152 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2154 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2155 int left_p, right_p;
2156 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2157 XRectangle clip_rect;
2159 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2160 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2161 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2163 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2164 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2165 ? s->first_glyph
2166 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2168 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2169 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2170 left_x = s->x;
2171 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2172 ? last_x - 1
2173 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2174 top_y = s->y;
2175 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2177 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2178 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2179 && (s->prev == NULL
2180 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2181 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2182 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2183 && (s->next == NULL
2184 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2186 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2188 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2189 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2190 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2191 else
2193 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2194 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2195 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2200 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2202 static void
2203 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2205 int x = s->x;
2206 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2208 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2209 right of that line. */
2210 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2211 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2212 && s->slice.x == 0)
2213 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2215 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2216 by that margin. */
2217 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2218 x += s->img->hmargin;
2219 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2220 y += s->img->vmargin;
2222 if (s->img->pixmap)
2224 if (s->img->mask)
2226 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2227 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2228 trust on the shape extension to be available
2229 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2230 manually. */
2231 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2232 | GCFunction);
2233 XGCValues xgcv;
2234 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2236 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2237 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2238 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2239 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2240 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2242 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2243 image_rect.x = x;
2244 image_rect.y = y;
2245 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2246 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2247 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2248 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2249 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2250 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2252 else
2254 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2256 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2257 image_rect.x = x;
2258 image_rect.y = y;
2259 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2260 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2261 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2262 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2263 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2264 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2266 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2267 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2268 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2269 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2270 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2271 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2272 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2274 int relief = s->img->relief;
2275 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2276 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2277 x - relief, y - relief,
2278 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2279 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2283 else
2284 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2285 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2286 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2290 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2292 static void
2293 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2295 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2296 XRectangle r;
2297 int x = s->x;
2298 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2300 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2301 right of that line. */
2302 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2303 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2304 && s->slice.x == 0)
2305 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2307 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2308 by that margin. */
2309 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2310 x += s->img->hmargin;
2311 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2312 y += s->img->vmargin;
2314 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2315 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2317 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2318 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2320 else
2322 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2323 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2326 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2327 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2329 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2330 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2331 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2332 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2334 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2335 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2336 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2337 s->slice.y == 0,
2338 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2339 s->slice.x == 0,
2340 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2341 &r);
2345 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2347 static void
2348 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2350 int x = 0;
2351 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2353 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2354 right of that line. */
2355 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2356 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2357 && s->slice.x == 0)
2358 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2360 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2361 by that margin. */
2362 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2363 x += s->img->hmargin;
2364 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2365 y += s->img->vmargin;
2367 if (s->img->pixmap)
2369 if (s->img->mask)
2371 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2372 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2373 trust on the shape extension to be available
2374 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2375 manually. */
2376 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2377 | GCFunction);
2378 XGCValues xgcv;
2380 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2381 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2382 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2383 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2384 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2386 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2387 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2388 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2389 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2391 else
2393 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2394 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2395 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2397 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2398 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2399 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2400 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2401 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2402 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2403 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2405 int r = s->img->relief;
2406 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2407 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2408 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2409 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2413 else
2414 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2415 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2416 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2420 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2421 give the rectangle to draw. */
2423 static void
2424 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2426 if (s->stippled_p)
2428 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2429 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2430 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2431 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2433 else
2434 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2438 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2440 s->y
2441 s->x +-------------------------
2442 | s->face->box
2444 | +-------------------------
2445 | | s->img->margin
2447 | | +-------------------
2448 | | | the image
2452 static void
2453 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2455 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2456 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2457 int height;
2458 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2460 height = s->height;
2461 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2462 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2463 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2464 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2466 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2467 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2468 flickering. */
2469 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2470 if (height > s->slice.height
2471 || s->img->hmargin
2472 || s->img->vmargin
2473 || s->img->mask
2474 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2475 || s->width != s->background_width)
2477 if (s->img->mask)
2479 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2480 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2481 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2482 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2483 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2485 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2486 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2487 s->background_width,
2488 s->height, depth);
2490 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2491 pixmap. */
2492 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2494 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2495 if (s->stippled_p)
2497 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2498 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2499 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2500 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2501 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2502 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2503 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2505 else
2507 XGCValues xgcv;
2508 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2509 &xgcv);
2510 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2511 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2512 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2513 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2516 else
2518 int x = s->x;
2519 int y = s->y;
2521 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2522 && s->slice.x == 0)
2523 x += box_line_hwidth;
2525 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2526 y += box_line_vwidth;
2528 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2531 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2534 /* Draw the foreground. */
2535 if (pixmap != None)
2537 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2538 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2539 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2540 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2541 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2543 else
2544 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2546 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2547 if (s->img->relief
2548 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2549 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2550 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2554 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2556 static void
2557 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2559 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2561 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2562 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2564 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2565 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2566 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2567 int x = s->x;
2569 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2571 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2573 if (x < left_x)
2575 background_width -= left_x - x;
2576 x = left_x;
2579 else
2581 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2582 stretch glyph. */
2583 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2585 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2586 background_width -= x - right_x;
2587 x += background_width;
2589 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2590 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2591 x -= width;
2593 /* Draw cursor. */
2594 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2596 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2597 if (width < background_width)
2599 int y = s->y;
2600 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2601 XRectangle r;
2602 GC gc;
2604 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2605 x += width;
2606 else
2607 x = s->x;
2608 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2609 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2611 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2612 gc = s->gc;
2614 else
2615 gc = s->face->gc;
2617 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2618 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2620 if (s->face->stipple)
2622 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2623 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2624 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2625 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2627 else
2629 XGCValues xgcv;
2630 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2631 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2632 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2633 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2637 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2639 int background_width = s->background_width;
2640 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2642 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2643 except for header line and mode line. */
2644 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2646 background_width -= left_x - x;
2647 x = left_x;
2649 if (background_width > 0)
2650 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2653 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2657 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2659 static void
2660 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2662 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2664 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2665 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2666 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2667 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2669 int width;
2670 struct glyph_string *next;
2672 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2673 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2674 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2675 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2677 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2678 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2679 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2680 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2681 else
2682 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2683 next->num_clips = 0;
2687 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2688 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2690 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2691 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2692 if (!s->for_overlaps
2693 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2694 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2695 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2698 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2699 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2700 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2701 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2702 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2704 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2705 && !s->clip_tail
2706 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2707 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2708 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2709 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2710 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2711 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2712 else
2713 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2715 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2717 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2718 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2719 break;
2721 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2722 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2723 break;
2725 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2726 if (s->for_overlaps)
2727 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2728 else
2729 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2730 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2731 break;
2733 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2734 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2735 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2736 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2737 else
2738 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2739 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2740 break;
2742 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2743 if (s->for_overlaps)
2744 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2745 else
2746 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2747 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2748 break;
2750 default:
2751 abort ();
2754 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2756 /* Draw underline. */
2757 if (s->face->underline_p)
2759 unsigned long thickness, position;
2760 int y;
2762 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2764 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2765 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2766 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2768 else
2770 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2771 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2772 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2773 else
2774 thickness = 1;
2775 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2776 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2777 else
2779 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2780 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2781 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2782 specs, and its default is
2784 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2785 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2787 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2788 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2789 position = s->font->underline_position;
2790 else if (s->font)
2791 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2792 else
2793 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2795 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2797 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2798 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2799 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2800 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2801 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2802 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2803 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2804 s->underline_position = position;
2805 y = s->ybase + position;
2806 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2807 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2808 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2809 else
2811 XGCValues xgcv;
2812 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2813 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2814 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2815 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2816 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2820 /* Draw overline. */
2821 if (s->face->overline_p)
2823 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2825 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2826 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2827 s->width, h);
2828 else
2830 XGCValues xgcv;
2831 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2832 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2833 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2834 s->width, h);
2835 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2839 /* Draw strike-through. */
2840 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2842 unsigned long h = 1;
2843 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2845 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2846 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2847 s->width, h);
2848 else
2850 XGCValues xgcv;
2851 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2852 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2853 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2854 s->width, h);
2855 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2859 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2860 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2861 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2863 if (s->prev)
2865 struct glyph_string *prev;
2867 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2868 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2869 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2871 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2872 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2873 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2875 prev->hl = s->hl;
2876 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2877 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2878 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2879 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2880 else
2881 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2882 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2883 prev->hl = save;
2884 prev->num_clips = 0;
2888 if (s->next)
2890 struct glyph_string *next;
2892 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2893 if (next->hl != s->hl
2894 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2896 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2897 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2898 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2900 next->hl = s->hl;
2901 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2902 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2903 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2904 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2905 else
2906 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2907 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2908 next->hl = save;
2909 next->num_clips = 0;
2914 /* Reset clipping. */
2915 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2916 s->num_clips = 0;
2919 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2921 static void
2922 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2924 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2925 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2926 x, y, width, height,
2927 x + shift_by, y);
2930 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2931 for X frames. */
2933 static void
2934 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2936 abort ();
2940 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2941 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2943 void
2944 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2946 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2947 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2951 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2953 static void
2954 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2956 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2957 longer visible. */
2958 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2959 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2960 output_cursor.x = -1;
2962 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2963 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2964 BLOCK_INPUT;
2966 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2968 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
2969 something like that, then they should be notified. */
2970 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2972 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2973 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2974 redisplay, do it here. */
2975 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2976 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2977 #endif
2979 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2981 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2986 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2988 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2989 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2991 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2994 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2995 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2997 static int
2998 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
3000 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
3001 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
3002 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
3004 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
3005 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
3006 y.tv_sec += nsec;
3009 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
3011 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
3012 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
3013 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
3016 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
3017 positive. */
3018 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
3019 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
3021 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
3022 negative. */
3023 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
3026 static void
3027 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3029 BLOCK_INPUT;
3032 #ifdef USE_GTK
3033 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3034 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3035 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3036 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3037 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3038 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3039 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3040 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3041 do { \
3042 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3043 cairo_fill (cr); \
3045 while (0)
3046 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3047 GdkGCValues vals;
3048 GdkGC *gc;
3049 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3050 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3051 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3052 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3053 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3054 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3055 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3056 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3057 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3058 GC gc;
3060 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3061 pixels into background pixels. */
3063 XGCValues values;
3065 values.function = GXxor;
3066 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3067 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3069 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3070 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3072 #endif
3074 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3075 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3076 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3077 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3078 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3079 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3080 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3082 int width;
3084 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3085 edge it is next to. */
3086 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3088 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3089 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3090 break;
3092 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3093 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3094 break;
3096 default:
3097 break;
3100 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3102 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3103 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3105 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3106 flash_left,
3107 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3108 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3109 width, flash_height);
3110 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3111 flash_left,
3112 (height - flash_height
3113 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3114 width, flash_height);
3117 else
3118 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3119 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3120 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3121 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3123 x_flush (f);
3126 struct timeval wakeup;
3128 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3130 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3131 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3132 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3133 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3135 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3136 available. */
3137 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3139 struct timeval current;
3140 struct timeval timeout;
3142 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3144 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3145 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3146 break;
3148 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3149 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3150 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3152 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3153 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3157 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3158 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3160 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3161 flash_left,
3162 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3163 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3164 width, flash_height);
3165 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3166 flash_left,
3167 (height - flash_height
3168 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3169 width, flash_height);
3171 else
3172 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3173 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3174 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3175 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3177 #ifdef USE_GTK
3178 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3179 cairo_destroy (cr);
3180 #else
3181 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3182 #endif
3183 #undef XFillRectangle
3184 #else
3185 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3186 #endif
3187 x_flush (f);
3191 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3194 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3197 static void
3198 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3200 BLOCK_INPUT;
3201 if (invisible)
3203 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3204 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3205 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3207 else
3208 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3209 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3210 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3211 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3215 /* Make audible bell. */
3217 static void
3218 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3220 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3222 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3223 if (visible_bell)
3224 XTflash (f);
3225 else
3226 #endif
3228 BLOCK_INPUT;
3229 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3230 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3231 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3237 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3238 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3239 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3240 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3242 static void
3243 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3245 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3250 /***********************************************************************
3251 Line Dance
3252 ***********************************************************************/
3254 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3255 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3257 static void
3258 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3260 abort ();
3264 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3266 static void
3267 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3269 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3270 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3272 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3273 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3274 fringe of W. */
3275 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3277 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3278 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3279 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3280 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3281 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3282 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3283 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3284 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3286 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3288 if (sb_width > 0)
3290 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3291 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3292 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3294 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3296 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3297 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3299 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3300 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3303 #endif
3305 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3306 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3307 bottom_y = y + height;
3309 if (to_y < from_y)
3311 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3312 line at the bottom. */
3313 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3314 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3315 else
3316 height = run->height;
3318 else
3320 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3321 at the bottom. */
3322 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3323 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3324 else
3325 height = run->height;
3328 BLOCK_INPUT;
3330 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3331 updated_window = w;
3332 x_clear_cursor (w);
3334 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3335 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3336 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3337 x, from_y,
3338 width, height,
3339 x, to_y);
3341 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3346 /***********************************************************************
3347 Exposure Events
3348 ***********************************************************************/
3351 static void
3352 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3354 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3355 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3356 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3357 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3358 BLOCK_INPUT;
3359 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3360 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3361 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3362 because of this (bug#9310). */
3363 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3364 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3365 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3366 x_uncatch_errors ();
3367 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3368 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3369 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3372 static void
3373 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3375 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3376 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3377 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3378 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3379 BLOCK_INPUT;
3380 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3381 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3382 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3383 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3384 x_uncatch_errors ();
3385 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3386 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3387 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3390 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3391 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3392 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3393 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3394 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3396 static void
3397 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3399 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3401 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3403 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3404 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3405 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3407 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3408 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3410 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3411 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3412 else
3413 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3416 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3419 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3420 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3421 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3423 static void
3424 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3426 if (type == FocusIn)
3428 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3430 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3431 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3433 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3434 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3435 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3436 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3437 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3439 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3440 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3444 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3446 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3447 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3448 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3449 #endif
3451 else if (type == FocusOut)
3453 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3455 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3457 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3458 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3461 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3462 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3463 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3464 #endif
3465 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3466 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3470 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3471 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3473 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3475 static void
3476 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3478 struct frame *frame;
3480 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3481 if (! frame)
3482 return;
3484 switch (event->type)
3486 case EnterNotify:
3487 case LeaveNotify:
3489 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3490 int focus_state
3491 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3493 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3494 && event->xcrossing.focus
3495 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3496 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3497 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3498 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3500 break;
3502 case FocusIn:
3503 case FocusOut:
3504 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3505 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3506 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3507 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3508 break;
3510 case ClientMessage:
3511 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3513 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3514 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3515 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3517 break;
3522 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3523 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3525 void
3526 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3528 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3530 #endif
3532 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3533 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3534 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3536 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3537 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3538 the appropriate X display info. */
3540 static void
3541 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3543 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3546 static void
3547 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3549 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3551 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3553 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3554 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3555 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3556 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3557 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3559 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3560 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3563 else
3564 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3566 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3568 if (old_highlight)
3569 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3570 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3571 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3577 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3579 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3580 static void
3581 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3583 int min_code, max_code;
3584 KeySym *syms;
3585 int syms_per_code;
3586 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3588 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3589 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3590 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3591 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3592 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3594 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3596 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3597 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3598 &syms_per_code);
3599 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3601 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3602 Alt keysyms are on. */
3604 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3605 int found_alt_or_meta;
3607 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3609 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3610 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3612 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3614 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3615 if (code == 0)
3616 continue;
3618 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3620 int code_col;
3622 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3624 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3626 switch (sym)
3628 case XK_Meta_L:
3629 case XK_Meta_R:
3630 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3631 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3632 break;
3634 case XK_Alt_L:
3635 case XK_Alt_R:
3636 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3637 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3638 break;
3640 case XK_Hyper_L:
3641 case XK_Hyper_R:
3642 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3643 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3644 code_col = syms_per_code;
3645 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3646 break;
3648 case XK_Super_L:
3649 case XK_Super_R:
3650 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3651 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3652 code_col = syms_per_code;
3653 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3654 break;
3656 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3657 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3658 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3659 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3660 code_col = syms_per_code;
3661 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3662 break;
3670 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3671 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3673 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3674 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3677 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3678 make them just meta, not alt. */
3679 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3681 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3684 XFree ((char *) syms);
3685 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3688 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3689 Emacs uses. */
3691 EMACS_INT
3692 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3694 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3695 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3696 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3697 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3698 Lisp_Object tem;
3700 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3701 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3702 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3703 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3704 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3705 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3706 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3707 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3710 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3711 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3712 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3713 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3714 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3715 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3718 static int
3719 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3721 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3722 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3723 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3724 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3726 Lisp_Object tem;
3728 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3729 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3730 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3731 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3732 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3733 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3734 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3735 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3738 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3739 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3740 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3741 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3742 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3743 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3746 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3748 char *
3749 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3751 char *value;
3753 BLOCK_INPUT;
3754 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3755 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3757 return value;
3762 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3764 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3766 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3767 the mouse. */
3769 static Lisp_Object
3770 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3772 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3773 otherwise. */
3774 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3775 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3776 result->timestamp = event->time;
3777 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3778 event->state)
3779 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3780 ? up_modifier
3781 : down_modifier));
3783 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3784 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3785 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3786 result->arg = Qnil;
3787 return Qnil;
3791 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3792 The input handler calls this.
3794 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3795 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3796 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3797 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3799 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3800 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3802 static int
3803 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3805 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3806 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3807 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3809 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3810 return 0;
3812 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3814 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3815 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3816 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3817 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3818 return 1;
3822 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3823 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3824 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3825 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3826 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3827 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3829 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3830 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3831 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3832 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3833 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3834 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3835 return 1;
3838 return 0;
3842 /************************************************************************
3843 Mouse Face
3844 ************************************************************************/
3846 static void
3847 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3849 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3850 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3851 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3852 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3853 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3858 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3859 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3861 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3862 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3863 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3864 position on the scroll bar.
3866 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3867 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3868 the mouse is over.
3870 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3871 was at this position.
3873 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3875 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3876 movement. */
3878 static void
3879 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3880 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3881 Time *timestamp)
3883 FRAME_PTR f1;
3885 BLOCK_INPUT;
3887 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3888 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3889 else
3891 Window root;
3892 int root_x, root_y;
3894 Window dummy_window;
3895 int dummy;
3897 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3899 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3900 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3901 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3902 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3903 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3905 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3907 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3908 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3909 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3911 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3912 &root,
3914 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3915 a different screen. */
3916 &dummy_window,
3918 /* The position on that root window. */
3919 &root_x, &root_y,
3921 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3922 &dummy, &dummy,
3924 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3925 we don't care. */
3926 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3928 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3929 containing the pointer. */
3931 Window win, child;
3932 int win_x, win_y;
3933 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3935 win = root;
3937 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3938 structure is changing at the same time this function
3939 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3941 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3943 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3944 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3946 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3947 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3948 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3950 /* From-window, to-window. */
3951 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3953 /* From-position, to-position. */
3954 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3956 /* Child of win. */
3957 &child);
3958 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3960 else
3962 while (1)
3964 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3966 /* From-window, to-window. */
3967 root, win,
3969 /* From-position, to-position. */
3970 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3972 /* Child of win. */
3973 &child);
3975 if (child == None || child == win)
3976 break;
3977 #ifdef USE_GTK
3978 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3979 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3980 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3981 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3982 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3983 break;
3984 #endif
3985 win = child;
3986 parent_x = win_x;
3987 parent_y = win_y;
3990 /* Now we know that:
3991 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3992 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3993 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3994 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3995 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3996 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3997 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3998 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3999 never use them in that case.) */
4001 #ifdef USE_GTK
4002 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4003 want the edit window. */
4004 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4005 #else
4006 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4007 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4008 #endif
4010 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4011 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4012 on the frame. */
4013 if (f1 != NULL
4014 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4015 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4016 f1 = NULL;
4017 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4020 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4021 f1 = 0;
4023 x_uncatch_errors ();
4025 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4026 if (! f1)
4028 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4030 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4032 if (bar)
4034 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4035 win_x = parent_x;
4036 win_y = parent_y;
4040 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4041 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4043 if (f1)
4045 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4046 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4047 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4048 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4049 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4050 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4051 the frame are divided into. */
4053 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4054 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4056 *bar_window = Qnil;
4057 *part = 0;
4058 *fp = f1;
4059 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4060 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4061 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4066 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4071 /***********************************************************************
4072 Scroll bars
4073 ***********************************************************************/
4075 /* Scroll bar support. */
4077 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4078 manages it.
4079 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4080 bits. */
4082 static struct scroll_bar *
4083 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4085 Lisp_Object tail;
4087 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4088 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4089 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4091 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4093 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4095 frame = XCAR (tail);
4096 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4097 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4098 abort ();
4100 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4101 continue;
4103 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4104 right window ID. */
4105 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4106 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4107 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4108 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4109 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4110 condemned = Qnil,
4111 ! NILP (bar));
4112 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4113 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4114 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4115 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4118 return NULL;
4122 #if defined USE_LUCID
4124 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4125 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4127 static Widget
4128 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4130 Lisp_Object tail;
4132 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4134 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4136 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4137 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4139 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4140 return menu_bar;
4144 return NULL;
4147 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4150 /************************************************************************
4151 Toolkit scroll bars
4152 ************************************************************************/
4154 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4156 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4157 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4158 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4159 struct scroll_bar *);
4160 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4161 int, int, int);
4164 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4165 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4167 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4169 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4171 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4173 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4174 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4176 #ifndef USE_GTK
4177 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4179 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4181 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4183 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4184 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4185 to avoid jerkiness. */
4187 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4189 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4190 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4191 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4192 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4194 static void
4195 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4196 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4198 int scroll_bar_p;
4199 const char *end_action;
4201 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4202 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4203 end_action = "Release";
4204 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4205 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4206 end_action = "EndScroll";
4207 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4209 if (scroll_bar_p
4210 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4211 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4213 struct window *w;
4215 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4216 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4217 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4219 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4221 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4222 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4223 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4225 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4226 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4228 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4229 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4232 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4234 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4235 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4237 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4238 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4241 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4242 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4243 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4244 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4246 static void
4247 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4249 XEvent event;
4250 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4251 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4252 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4253 ptrdiff_t i;
4255 BLOCK_INPUT;
4257 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4258 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4259 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4260 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4261 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4262 ev->format = 32;
4264 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4265 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4266 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4267 into that array in the event. */
4268 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4269 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4270 break;
4272 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4274 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4275 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4276 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4277 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4278 scroll_bar_windows =
4279 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4280 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4281 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4282 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4285 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4286 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4287 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4288 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4289 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4290 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4292 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4293 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4294 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4295 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4296 #endif
4298 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4299 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4300 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4301 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4302 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4306 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4307 in *IEVENT. */
4309 static void
4310 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4312 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4313 Lisp_Object window;
4314 struct window *w;
4316 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4317 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4319 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4321 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4322 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4323 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4324 #ifdef USE_GTK
4325 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4326 #else
4327 ievent->timestamp =
4328 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4329 #endif
4330 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4331 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4332 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4333 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4334 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4338 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4340 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4342 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4345 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4346 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4347 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4349 static void
4350 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4352 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4353 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4354 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4356 switch (cs->reason)
4358 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4359 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4360 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4361 break;
4363 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4364 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4365 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4366 break;
4368 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4369 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4370 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4371 break;
4373 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4374 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4375 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4376 break;
4378 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4379 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4380 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4381 break;
4383 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4384 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4385 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4386 break;
4388 case XmCR_DRAG:
4390 int slider_size;
4392 /* Get the slider size. */
4393 BLOCK_INPUT;
4394 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4395 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4397 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4398 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4399 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4400 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4402 break;
4404 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4405 break;
4408 if (part >= 0)
4410 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4411 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4412 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4416 #elif defined USE_GTK
4418 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4419 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4421 static gboolean
4422 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4423 GtkScrollType scroll,
4424 gdouble value,
4425 gpointer user_data)
4427 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4428 gdouble position;
4429 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4430 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4431 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4433 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4434 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4437 switch (scroll)
4439 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4440 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4441 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4442 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4444 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4445 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4446 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4447 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4448 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4450 break;
4451 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4452 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4453 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4454 break;
4455 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4456 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4457 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4458 break;
4459 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4460 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4461 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4462 break;
4463 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4464 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4465 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4466 break;
4469 if (part >= 0)
4471 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4472 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4473 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4476 return FALSE;
4479 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4481 static gboolean
4482 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4483 GdkEventButton *event,
4484 gpointer user_data)
4486 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4487 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4488 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4490 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4491 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4492 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4495 return FALSE;
4499 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4501 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4502 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4503 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4504 the thumb is. */
4506 static void
4507 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4509 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4510 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4511 float shown;
4512 int whole, portion, height;
4513 int part;
4515 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4516 BLOCK_INPUT;
4517 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4518 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4520 whole = 10000000;
4521 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4523 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4524 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4525 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4526 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4527 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4528 bottom). */
4529 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4530 else
4531 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4533 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4534 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4535 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4536 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4540 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4541 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4542 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4543 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4544 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4545 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4546 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4548 static void
4549 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4551 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4552 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4553 int position = (long) call_data;
4554 Dimension height;
4555 int part;
4557 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4558 BLOCK_INPUT;
4559 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4560 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4562 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4563 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4565 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4566 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4567 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4568 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4569 else
4570 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4572 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4573 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4574 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4575 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4578 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4580 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4582 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4583 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4585 #ifdef USE_GTK
4586 static void
4587 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4589 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4591 BLOCK_INPUT;
4592 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4593 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4594 scroll_bar_name);
4595 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4598 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4600 static void
4601 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4603 Window xwindow;
4604 Widget widget;
4605 Arg av[20];
4606 int ac = 0;
4607 char const *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4608 unsigned long pixel;
4610 BLOCK_INPUT;
4612 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4613 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4614 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4615 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4616 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4617 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4618 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4619 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4620 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4622 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4623 if (pixel != -1)
4625 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4626 ++ac;
4629 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4630 if (pixel != -1)
4632 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4633 ++ac;
4636 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4637 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4639 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4640 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4641 (XtPointer) bar);
4642 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4643 (XtPointer) bar);
4644 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4645 (XtPointer) bar);
4646 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4647 (XtPointer) bar);
4648 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4649 (XtPointer) bar);
4650 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4651 (XtPointer) bar);
4652 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4653 (XtPointer) bar);
4655 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4656 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4658 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4659 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4660 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4661 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4663 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4665 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4666 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4667 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4668 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4669 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4670 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4671 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4672 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4674 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4675 if (pixel != -1)
4677 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4678 ++ac;
4681 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4682 if (pixel != -1)
4684 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4685 ++ac;
4688 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4690 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4691 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4693 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4694 if (pixel != -1)
4696 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4697 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4698 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4699 pixel = -1;
4700 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4703 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4705 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4706 if (pixel != -1)
4708 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4709 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4710 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4711 pixel = -1;
4712 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4716 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4717 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4718 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4719 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4720 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4721 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4722 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4723 colors itself. */
4725 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4726 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4727 ++ac;
4729 else
4730 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4731 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4732 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4734 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4735 the shadows. */
4736 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4737 ++ac;
4739 /* Specify the colors. */
4740 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4741 if (pixel != -1)
4743 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4744 ++ac;
4746 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4747 if (pixel != -1)
4749 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4750 ++ac;
4753 #endif
4755 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4756 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4759 char const *initial = "";
4760 char const *val = initial;
4761 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4762 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4763 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4764 #endif
4765 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4766 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4767 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4768 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4769 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4770 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4774 /* Define callbacks. */
4775 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4776 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4777 (XtPointer) bar);
4779 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4780 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4782 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4784 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4785 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4786 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4787 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4789 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4790 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4791 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4792 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4794 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4796 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4799 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4800 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4802 #ifdef USE_GTK
4803 static void
4804 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4806 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4809 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4810 static void
4811 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4812 int whole)
4814 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4815 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4816 float top, shown;
4818 BLOCK_INPUT;
4820 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4822 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4823 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4824 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4825 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4826 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4827 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4828 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4829 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4830 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4831 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4832 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4833 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4834 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4835 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4836 whole += portion;
4838 if (whole <= 0)
4839 top = 0, shown = 1;
4840 else
4842 top = (float) position / whole;
4843 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4846 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4848 int size, value;
4850 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4851 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4852 value. */
4853 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4854 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4855 size = max (size, 1);
4857 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4858 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4859 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4861 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4863 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4865 if (whole == 0)
4866 top = 0, shown = 1;
4867 else
4869 top = (float) position / whole;
4870 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4874 float old_top, old_shown;
4875 Dimension height;
4876 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4877 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4878 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4879 XtNheight, &height,
4880 NULL);
4882 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4883 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4884 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4885 else
4886 top = old_top;
4887 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4888 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4890 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4891 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4892 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4893 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4895 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4896 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4897 else
4899 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4900 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4901 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4903 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4907 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4909 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4911 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4913 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4917 /************************************************************************
4918 Scroll bars, general
4919 ************************************************************************/
4921 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4922 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4923 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4924 scroll bar. */
4926 static struct scroll_bar *
4927 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4929 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4930 struct scroll_bar *bar
4931 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4933 BLOCK_INPUT;
4935 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4936 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4937 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4939 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4940 unsigned long mask;
4941 Window window;
4943 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4944 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4945 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4947 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4948 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4949 | ExposureMask);
4950 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4952 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4954 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4955 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4956 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4957 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4958 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4959 left, top, width,
4960 window_box_height (w), False);
4962 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4963 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4964 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4965 top,
4966 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4967 height,
4968 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4970 CopyFromParent,
4971 CopyFromParent,
4972 CopyFromParent,
4973 /* Attributes. */
4974 mask, &a);
4975 bar->x_window = window;
4977 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4979 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4980 bar->top = top;
4981 bar->left = left;
4982 bar->width = width;
4983 bar->height = height;
4984 bar->start = 0;
4985 bar->end = 0;
4986 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4987 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4989 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4990 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4991 bar->prev = Qnil;
4992 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4993 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4994 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4996 /* Map the window/widget. */
4997 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4999 #ifdef USE_GTK
5000 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5001 bar->x_window,
5002 top,
5003 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5004 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5005 max (height, 1));
5006 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5007 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5008 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5009 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5010 top,
5011 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5012 max (height, 1), 0);
5013 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5014 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5016 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5017 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5018 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5020 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5021 return bar;
5025 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5027 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5029 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5030 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5031 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5032 events.)
5034 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5035 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5036 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5037 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5038 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5040 static void
5041 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5043 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5044 Window w = bar->x_window;
5045 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5046 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5048 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5049 if (! rebuild
5050 && start == bar->start
5051 && end == bar->end)
5052 return;
5054 BLOCK_INPUT;
5057 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5058 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5059 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5061 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5062 the distance between start and end. */
5064 int length = end - start;
5066 if (start < 0)
5067 start = 0;
5068 else if (start > top_range)
5069 start = top_range;
5070 end = start + length;
5072 if (end < start)
5073 end = start;
5074 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5075 end = top_range;
5078 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5079 bar->start = start;
5080 bar->end = end;
5082 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5083 if (end > top_range)
5084 end = top_range;
5086 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5087 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5088 that many pixels tall. */
5089 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5091 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5092 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5093 if (0 < start)
5094 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5095 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5096 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5097 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5098 inside_width, start,
5099 False);
5101 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5102 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5103 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5104 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5106 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5107 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5108 /* x, y, width, height */
5109 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5110 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5111 inside_width, end - start);
5113 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5114 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5115 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5116 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5118 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5119 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5120 if (end < inside_height)
5121 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5122 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5123 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5124 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5125 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5126 False);
5130 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5133 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5135 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5136 nil. */
5138 static void
5139 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5141 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5142 BLOCK_INPUT;
5144 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5145 #ifdef USE_GTK
5146 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5147 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5148 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5149 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5150 #else
5151 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5152 #endif
5154 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5155 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5157 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5161 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5162 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5163 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5164 create one. */
5166 static void
5167 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5169 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5170 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5171 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5172 int window_y, window_height;
5173 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5174 int fringe_extended_p;
5175 #endif
5177 /* Get window dimensions. */
5178 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5179 top = window_y;
5180 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5181 height = window_height;
5183 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5184 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5186 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5187 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5188 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5189 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5190 else
5191 sb_width = width;
5193 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5194 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5195 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5196 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5197 else
5198 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5199 #else
5200 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5201 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5202 else
5203 sb_left = left;
5204 #endif
5206 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5207 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5208 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5209 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5210 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5211 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5212 else
5213 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5214 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5215 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5216 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5217 #endif
5219 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5220 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5222 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5224 BLOCK_INPUT;
5225 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5226 if (fringe_extended_p)
5227 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5228 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5229 else
5230 #endif
5231 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5232 left, top, width, height, False);
5233 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5236 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5238 else
5240 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5241 unsigned int mask = 0;
5243 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5245 BLOCK_INPUT;
5247 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5248 mask |= CWX;
5249 if (top != bar->top)
5250 mask |= CWY;
5251 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5252 mask |= CWWidth;
5253 if (height != bar->height)
5254 mask |= CWHeight;
5256 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5258 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5259 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5261 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5262 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5263 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5265 if (fringe_extended_p)
5266 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5267 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5268 else
5269 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5270 left, top, width, height, False);
5272 #ifdef USE_GTK
5273 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5274 bar->x_window,
5275 top,
5276 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5277 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5278 max (height, 1));
5279 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5280 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5281 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5282 top,
5283 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5284 max (height, 1), 0);
5285 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5287 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5289 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5290 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5291 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5293 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5294 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5295 height, False);
5296 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5297 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5298 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5299 height, False);
5302 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5303 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5304 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5305 example. */
5307 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5308 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5309 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5311 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5312 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5313 left + area_width - rest, top,
5314 rest, height, False);
5315 else
5316 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5317 left, top, rest, height, False);
5321 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5322 if (mask)
5324 XWindowChanges wc;
5326 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5327 wc.y = top;
5328 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5329 wc.height = height;
5330 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5331 mask, &wc);
5334 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5336 /* Remember new settings. */
5337 bar->left = sb_left;
5338 bar->top = top;
5339 bar->width = sb_width;
5340 bar->height = height;
5342 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5345 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5346 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5348 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5349 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5350 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5351 dragged. */
5352 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5354 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5356 if (whole == 0)
5357 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5358 else
5360 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5361 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5362 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5365 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5367 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5371 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5372 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5373 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5374 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5375 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5376 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5377 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5379 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5380 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5381 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5383 static void
5384 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5386 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5387 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5389 Lisp_Object bar;
5390 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5391 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5392 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5393 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5394 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5395 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5396 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5401 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5402 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5404 static void
5405 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5407 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5408 struct frame *f;
5410 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5411 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5412 abort ();
5414 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5416 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5417 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5418 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5420 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5421 the lists. */
5422 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5423 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5424 return;
5425 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5426 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5427 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5428 else
5429 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5430 one or the other! */
5431 abort ();
5433 else
5434 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5436 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5437 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5439 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5440 bar->prev = Qnil;
5441 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5442 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5443 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5446 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5447 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5449 static void
5450 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5452 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5454 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5456 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5457 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5458 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5460 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5462 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5464 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5466 next = b->next;
5467 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5470 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5471 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5475 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5476 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5477 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5479 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5480 mark bits. */
5482 static void
5483 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5485 Window w = bar->x_window;
5486 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5487 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5488 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5490 BLOCK_INPUT;
5492 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5494 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5495 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5496 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5497 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5499 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5500 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5502 /* x, y, width, height */
5503 0, 0,
5504 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5505 bar->height - 1);
5507 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5508 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5509 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5510 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5512 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5515 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5517 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5518 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5520 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5521 mark bits. */
5524 static void
5525 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5527 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5528 abort ();
5530 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5531 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5532 emacs_event->modifiers
5533 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5534 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5535 event->xbutton.state)
5536 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5537 ? up_modifier
5538 : down_modifier));
5539 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5540 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5541 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5543 int top_range
5544 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5545 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5547 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5548 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5550 if (y < bar->start)
5551 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5552 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5553 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5554 else
5555 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5557 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5558 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5559 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5560 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5562 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5563 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5565 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5566 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5568 #endif
5570 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5571 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5575 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5577 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5579 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5580 mark bits. */
5582 static void
5583 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5585 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5587 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5589 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5590 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5592 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5593 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5595 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5596 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5598 if (new_start != bar->start)
5600 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5602 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5607 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5609 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5610 on the scroll bar. */
5612 static void
5613 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5614 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5615 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5617 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5618 Window w = bar->x_window;
5619 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5620 int win_x, win_y;
5621 Window dummy_window;
5622 int dummy_coord;
5623 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5625 BLOCK_INPUT;
5627 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5628 report that. */
5629 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5631 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5632 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5633 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5635 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5636 &win_x, &win_y,
5638 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5639 &dummy_mask))
5641 else
5643 int top_range
5644 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5646 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5648 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5649 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5651 if (win_y < 0)
5652 win_y = 0;
5653 if (win_y > top_range)
5654 win_y = top_range;
5656 *fp = f;
5657 *bar_window = bar->window;
5659 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5660 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5661 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5662 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5663 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5664 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5665 else
5666 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5668 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5669 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5671 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5672 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5675 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5677 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5681 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5682 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5683 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5684 redraw them. */
5686 static void
5687 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5689 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5690 Lisp_Object bar;
5692 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5693 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5694 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5695 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5696 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5697 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5698 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5699 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5700 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5701 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5705 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5707 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5708 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5709 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5710 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5712 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5713 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5715 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5717 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5718 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5720 static int temp_index;
5721 static short temp_buffer[100];
5723 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5724 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5725 temp_index = 0; \
5726 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5728 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5729 on a particular display. */
5731 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5733 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5734 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5735 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5736 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5738 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5740 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5741 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5742 do \
5744 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5745 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5746 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5747 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5748 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5749 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5751 while (0)
5752 #endif
5754 enum
5756 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5757 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5758 X_EVENT_DROP
5761 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5762 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5763 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5765 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5766 this event further.
5767 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5769 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5770 static int
5771 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5773 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5774 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5775 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5776 was created. */
5778 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5779 event->xclient.window);
5781 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5783 #endif
5785 #ifdef USE_GTK
5786 static int current_count;
5787 static int current_finish;
5788 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5790 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5791 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5792 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5793 static GdkFilterReturn
5794 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5796 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5798 BLOCK_INPUT;
5799 if (current_count >= 0)
5801 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5803 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5805 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5806 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5807 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5808 so we do it here. */
5809 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5810 && dpyinfo
5811 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5813 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5814 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5816 #endif
5818 if (! dpyinfo)
5819 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5820 else
5821 current_count +=
5822 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5823 current_hold_quit);
5825 else
5826 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5828 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5830 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5831 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5833 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5835 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5838 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5839 enum xembed_message,
5840 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5842 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5844 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5845 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5846 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5848 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5850 static int
5851 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5852 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5854 union {
5855 struct input_event ie;
5856 struct selection_input_event sie;
5857 } inev;
5858 int count = 0;
5859 int do_help = 0;
5860 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5861 struct frame *f = NULL;
5862 struct coding_system coding;
5863 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5864 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5865 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5867 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5869 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5870 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5871 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5873 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5874 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5876 switch (event.type)
5878 case ClientMessage:
5880 if (event.xclient.message_type
5881 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5882 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5884 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5885 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5887 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5888 could be the shell widget window
5889 if the frame has no title bar. */
5890 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5891 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5892 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5893 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5894 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5895 #endif
5896 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5897 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5898 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5899 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5900 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5901 needed.
5903 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5904 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5905 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5906 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5907 Emacs. */
5909 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5910 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5911 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5912 if (f)
5914 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5915 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5916 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5917 x_catch_errors (d);
5918 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5919 /* The ICCCM says this is
5920 the only valid choice. */
5921 RevertToParent,
5922 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5923 /* This is needed to detect the error
5924 if there is an error. */
5925 XSync (d, False);
5926 x_uncatch_errors ();
5928 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5929 #endif /* 0 */
5930 goto done;
5933 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5934 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5936 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5937 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5938 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5939 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5940 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5941 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5942 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5943 session manager and one for this. */
5944 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5945 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5946 #endif
5948 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5949 event.xclient.window);
5950 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5951 for a single Emacs process. */
5952 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5953 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5954 event.xclient.window,
5955 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5956 else if (f)
5957 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5958 event.xclient.window,
5959 0, 0);
5961 goto done;
5964 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5965 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5967 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5968 event.xclient.window);
5969 if (!f)
5970 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5972 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5973 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5974 goto done;
5977 goto done;
5980 if (event.xclient.message_type
5981 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5983 goto done;
5986 if (event.xclient.message_type
5987 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5989 int new_x, new_y;
5990 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5992 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5993 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5995 if (f)
5997 f->left_pos = new_x;
5998 f->top_pos = new_y;
6000 goto done;
6003 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6004 if (event.xclient.message_type
6005 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6007 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6008 if (f)
6009 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6010 &event, NULL);
6011 goto done;
6013 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6015 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6016 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6017 || (event.xclient.message_type
6018 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6020 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6021 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6022 currently never do because we are interested in
6023 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6024 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6025 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6026 if (!f)
6027 goto OTHER;
6028 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6029 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6030 goto done;
6033 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6034 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6035 we construct an input_event. */
6036 if (event.xclient.message_type
6037 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6039 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6040 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6041 goto done;
6043 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6045 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6046 if (event.xclient.message_type
6047 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6049 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6050 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6051 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6053 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6054 goto done;
6057 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6059 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6060 if (!f)
6061 goto OTHER;
6062 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6063 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6065 break;
6067 case SelectionNotify:
6068 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6069 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6070 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6071 goto OTHER;
6072 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6073 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6074 break;
6076 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6077 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6078 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6079 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6080 goto OTHER;
6081 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6083 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6085 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6086 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6087 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6088 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6089 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6091 break;
6093 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6094 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6095 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6096 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6097 goto OTHER;
6098 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6100 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6102 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6103 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6104 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6105 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6106 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6107 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6108 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6109 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6111 break;
6113 case PropertyNotify:
6114 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6115 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6116 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6117 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6118 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6120 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6121 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6122 treat it as deiconified. */
6123 if (! f->async_iconified)
6124 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6125 f->async_visible = 1;
6126 f->async_iconified = 0;
6127 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6128 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6129 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6130 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6133 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6134 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6135 goto OTHER;
6137 case ReparentNotify:
6138 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6139 if (f)
6141 int x, y;
6142 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6143 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6144 f->left_pos = x;
6145 f->top_pos = y;
6147 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6148 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6149 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6151 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6153 goto OTHER;
6155 case Expose:
6156 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6157 if (f)
6159 #ifdef USE_GTK
6160 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6161 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6162 event.xexpose.window,
6163 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6164 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6165 FALSE);
6166 #endif
6167 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6169 f->async_visible = 1;
6170 f->async_iconified = 0;
6171 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6172 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6174 else
6175 expose_frame (f,
6176 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6177 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6179 else
6181 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6182 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6183 #endif
6184 #if defined USE_LUCID
6185 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6186 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6187 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6189 Widget widget
6190 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6191 if (widget)
6192 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6194 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6196 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6197 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6198 goto OTHER;
6199 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6200 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6201 event.xexpose.window);
6203 if (bar)
6204 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6205 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6206 else
6207 goto OTHER;
6208 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6209 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6211 break;
6213 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6214 source area was obscured or not
6215 available. */
6216 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6217 if (f)
6219 expose_frame (f,
6220 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6221 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6222 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6224 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6225 else
6226 goto OTHER;
6227 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6228 break;
6230 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6231 source area was completely
6232 available. */
6233 break;
6235 case UnmapNotify:
6236 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6237 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6239 tip_window = 0;
6240 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6243 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6244 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6245 the frame was deleted. */
6247 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6248 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6249 display that won't ever be seen. */
6250 f->async_visible = 0;
6251 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6252 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6253 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6254 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6255 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6256 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6257 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6259 f->async_iconified = 1;
6261 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6262 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6265 goto OTHER;
6267 case MapNotify:
6268 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6269 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6270 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6271 goto OTHER;
6273 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6274 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6275 frame is visible. */
6276 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6277 if (f)
6279 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6280 the frame's display structures.
6281 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6282 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6283 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6284 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6285 if (! f->async_iconified)
6286 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6288 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6289 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6290 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6291 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6293 f->async_visible = 1;
6294 f->async_iconified = 0;
6295 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6297 if (f->iconified)
6299 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6300 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6302 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6303 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6304 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6305 to update the frame titles
6306 in case this is the second frame. */
6307 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6309 #ifdef USE_GTK
6310 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6311 #endif
6313 goto OTHER;
6315 case KeyPress:
6317 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6318 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6320 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6321 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6322 if (popup_activated ())
6323 goto OTHER;
6324 #endif
6326 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6328 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6329 mouse highlighting. */
6330 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6331 && (f == 0
6332 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6334 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6335 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6338 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6339 if (f == 0)
6341 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6342 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6343 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6344 event.xkey.window);
6345 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6347 widget = XtParent (widget);
6348 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6351 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6353 if (f != 0)
6355 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6356 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6357 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6358 his Emacs hang.
6360 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6361 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6362 status_return even if the input is too long to
6363 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6364 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6365 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6366 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6367 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6368 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6369 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6370 int modifiers;
6371 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6372 Lisp_Object c;
6374 #ifdef USE_GTK
6375 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6376 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6377 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6378 (see above). */
6379 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6380 #endif
6382 event.xkey.state
6383 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6384 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6385 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6387 /* This will have to go some day... */
6389 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6390 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6391 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6392 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6393 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6394 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6395 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6397 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6398 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6399 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6400 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6401 not it is combined with Meta. */
6402 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6403 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6405 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6406 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6408 Status status_return;
6410 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6411 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6412 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6413 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6414 &status_return);
6415 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6417 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6418 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6419 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6420 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6421 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6422 &status_return);
6424 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6425 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6426 break;
6427 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6429 keysym = NoSymbol;
6430 modifiers = 0;
6432 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6433 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6434 abort ();
6436 else
6437 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6438 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6439 &compose_status);
6440 #else
6441 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6442 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6443 &compose_status);
6444 #endif
6446 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6447 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6448 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6449 break;
6451 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6452 orig_keysym = keysym;
6454 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6455 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6456 inev.ie.modifiers
6457 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6458 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6460 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6461 translations to characters. */
6462 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6463 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6465 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6466 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6467 goto done_keysym;
6470 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6471 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6473 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6474 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6475 else
6476 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6477 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6478 goto done_keysym;
6481 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6482 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6483 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6484 Vx_keysym_table,
6485 Qnil))))
6487 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6488 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6489 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6490 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6491 goto done_keysym;
6494 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6495 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6496 || keysym == XK_Delete
6497 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6498 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6499 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6500 #endif
6501 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6502 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6503 #ifdef HPUX
6504 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6505 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6506 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6507 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6508 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6509 #endif
6510 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6511 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6512 #endif
6513 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6514 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6515 #endif
6516 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6517 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6518 #endif
6519 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6520 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6521 #endif
6522 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6523 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6524 #endif
6525 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6526 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6527 #endif
6528 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6529 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6530 #endif
6531 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6532 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6533 #endif
6534 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6535 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6536 #endif
6537 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6538 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6539 #endif
6540 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6541 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6542 #endif
6543 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6544 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6545 #endif
6546 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6547 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6548 #endif
6549 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6550 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6551 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6552 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6553 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6554 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6555 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6556 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6557 don't have real modifiers but
6558 should be treated similarly to
6559 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6560 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6561 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6562 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6563 #endif
6566 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6567 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6568 key. */
6569 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6570 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6571 goto done_keysym;
6574 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6575 ptrdiff_t i;
6576 int nchars, len;
6578 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6580 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6581 nchars++;
6582 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6585 if (nchars < nbytes)
6587 /* Decode the input data. */
6589 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6590 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6591 we used just above and the locale. */
6592 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6593 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6594 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6595 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6596 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6597 gives us composition information. */
6598 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6600 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6601 nbytes);
6602 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6603 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6604 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6605 nbytes = coding.produced;
6606 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6607 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6610 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6611 character events. */
6612 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6614 int ch;
6615 if (nchars == nbytes)
6616 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6617 else
6618 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6619 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6620 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6621 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6622 inev.ie.code = ch;
6623 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6626 count += nchars;
6628 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6630 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6631 break;
6634 done_keysym:
6635 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6636 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6637 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6638 client. */
6639 break;
6640 #else
6641 goto OTHER;
6642 #endif
6644 case KeyRelease:
6645 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6646 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6647 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6648 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6649 client. */
6650 break;
6651 #else
6652 goto OTHER;
6653 #endif
6655 case EnterNotify:
6656 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6657 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6659 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6661 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6662 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6664 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6665 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6666 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6667 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6668 #ifdef USE_GTK
6669 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6670 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6671 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6672 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6673 #endif
6674 goto OTHER;
6676 case FocusIn:
6677 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6678 goto OTHER;
6680 case LeaveNotify:
6681 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6682 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6684 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6685 if (f)
6687 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6689 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6690 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6691 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6692 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6695 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6696 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6697 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6698 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6699 if (any_help_event_p)
6700 do_help = -1;
6702 #ifdef USE_GTK
6703 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6704 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6705 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6706 #endif
6707 goto OTHER;
6709 case FocusOut:
6710 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6711 goto OTHER;
6713 case MotionNotify:
6715 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6716 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6717 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6719 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6720 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6721 f = last_mouse_frame;
6722 else
6723 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6725 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6727 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6728 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6731 #ifdef USE_GTK
6732 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6733 f = 0;
6734 #endif
6735 if (f)
6738 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6739 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6740 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6742 Lisp_Object window;
6744 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6745 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6746 0, 0);
6748 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6749 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6750 will be selected only when it is active. */
6751 if (WINDOWP (window)
6752 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6753 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6754 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6755 create event iff we don't leave the
6756 selected frame. */
6757 && (focus_follows_mouse
6758 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6759 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6761 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6762 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6765 last_window=window;
6767 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6768 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6770 else
6772 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6773 struct scroll_bar *bar
6774 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6775 event.xmotion.window);
6777 if (bar)
6778 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6779 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6781 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6782 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6783 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6786 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6787 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6788 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6789 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6790 do_help = 1;
6791 goto OTHER;
6794 case ConfigureNotify:
6795 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6796 #ifdef USE_GTK
6797 if (!f
6798 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6799 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6801 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6802 event.xconfigure.height);
6803 f = 0;
6805 #endif
6806 if (f)
6808 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6809 #ifndef USE_GTK
6810 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6811 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6813 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6814 is called by the code that handles resizing
6815 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6817 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6818 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6819 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6820 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6821 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6822 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6823 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6825 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6826 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6827 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6830 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6831 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6832 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6833 #endif
6835 #ifdef USE_GTK
6836 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6837 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6838 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6839 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6840 #endif
6842 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6845 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6846 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6847 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6848 #endif
6851 goto OTHER;
6853 case ButtonRelease:
6854 case ButtonPress:
6856 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6857 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6858 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6860 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6861 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6862 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6864 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6865 && last_mouse_frame
6866 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6867 f = last_mouse_frame;
6868 else
6869 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6871 #ifdef USE_GTK
6872 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6873 f = 0;
6874 #endif
6875 if (f)
6877 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6878 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6879 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6881 Lisp_Object window;
6882 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6883 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6885 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6886 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6888 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6890 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6891 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6892 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6893 event.xbutton.state));
6897 if (!tool_bar_p)
6898 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6899 if (! popup_activated ())
6900 #endif
6902 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6904 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6905 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6907 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6908 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6910 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6911 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6913 else
6914 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6916 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6917 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6918 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6920 else
6922 struct scroll_bar *bar
6923 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6924 event.xbutton.window);
6926 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6927 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6928 scroll bars. */
6929 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6931 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6932 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6934 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6935 if (bar)
6936 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6937 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6940 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6942 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6943 last_mouse_frame = f;
6945 if (!tool_bar_p)
6946 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6948 else
6949 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6951 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6952 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6953 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6954 if (f != 0)
6955 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6957 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6958 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6959 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6960 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6961 Instead, save it away
6962 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6963 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6964 if (! popup_activated ()
6965 #ifdef USE_GTK
6966 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6967 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6968 #endif
6969 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6970 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6971 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6972 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6973 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6974 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6975 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6976 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6978 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6979 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6980 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6982 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6984 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6985 goto OTHER;
6987 else
6988 goto OTHER;
6989 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6991 break;
6993 case CirculateNotify:
6994 goto OTHER;
6996 case CirculateRequest:
6997 goto OTHER;
6999 case VisibilityNotify:
7000 goto OTHER;
7002 case MappingNotify:
7003 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7004 local cache. */
7005 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7007 case MappingModifier:
7008 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7009 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7010 case MappingKeyboard:
7011 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7013 goto OTHER;
7015 case DestroyNotify:
7016 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7017 break;
7019 default:
7020 OTHER:
7021 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7022 BLOCK_INPUT;
7023 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7024 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7025 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7026 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7027 break;
7030 done:
7031 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7033 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7034 count++;
7037 if (do_help
7038 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7040 Lisp_Object frame;
7042 if (f)
7043 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7044 else
7045 frame = Qnil;
7047 if (do_help > 0)
7049 any_help_event_p = 1;
7050 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7051 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7053 else
7055 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7056 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7058 count++;
7061 SAFE_FREE ();
7062 *eventptr = event;
7063 return count;
7066 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7068 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7069 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7070 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7072 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7074 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7076 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7077 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7079 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7081 if (dpyinfo)
7082 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7084 return finish;
7086 #endif
7089 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7090 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7091 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7093 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7094 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7095 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7096 C chars).
7098 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7100 static int
7101 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7103 int count = 0;
7104 int event_found = 0;
7106 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7108 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7109 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7110 pending_signals = 1;
7111 #endif
7112 return -1;
7115 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7116 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7117 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7118 #endif
7119 BLOCK_INPUT;
7121 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7122 input_signal_count++;
7124 ++handling_signal;
7126 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7127 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7129 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7130 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7133 #ifndef USE_GTK
7134 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7136 int finish;
7137 XEvent event;
7139 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7141 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7142 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7143 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7144 continue;
7145 #endif
7146 event_found = 1;
7148 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7149 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7151 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7152 goto out;
7155 out:;
7157 #else /* USE_GTK */
7159 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7160 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7161 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7162 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7164 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7165 from all displays. */
7167 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7169 current_count = count;
7170 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7172 gtk_main_iteration ();
7174 count = current_count;
7175 current_count = -1;
7176 current_hold_quit = 0;
7178 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7179 break;
7181 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7183 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7184 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7185 if (! event_found)
7187 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7188 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7189 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7190 x_noop_count++;
7191 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7193 x_noop_count=0;
7195 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7196 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7198 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7200 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7201 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7205 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7206 raise it now. */
7207 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7208 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7210 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7211 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7214 --handling_signal;
7215 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7217 return count;
7223 /***********************************************************************
7224 Text Cursor
7225 ***********************************************************************/
7227 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7228 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7230 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7231 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7232 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7234 static void
7235 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7237 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7238 XRectangle clip_rect;
7239 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7241 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7243 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7244 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7245 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7246 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7247 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7249 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7253 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7255 static void
7256 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7258 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7259 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7260 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7261 int x, y, wd, h;
7262 XGCValues xgcv;
7263 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7264 GC gc;
7266 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7267 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7268 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7269 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7270 return;
7272 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7273 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7274 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7276 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7277 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7278 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7279 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7280 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7281 else
7282 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7283 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7284 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7286 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7287 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7288 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7289 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7293 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7295 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7296 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7297 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7298 --gerd. */
7300 static void
7301 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7303 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7304 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7306 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7307 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7308 and mini-buffer. */
7309 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7310 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7311 return;
7313 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7314 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7315 the bar might not be in the window. */
7316 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7318 struct glyph_row *r;
7319 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7320 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7322 else
7324 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7325 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7326 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7327 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7328 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7329 XGCValues xgcv;
7331 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7332 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7333 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7334 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7335 that the glyph is legible. */
7336 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7337 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7338 else
7339 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7340 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7342 if (gc)
7343 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7344 else
7346 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7347 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7350 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7352 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7354 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7356 if (width < 0)
7357 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7358 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7360 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7362 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7363 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7364 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7365 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7367 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7368 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7369 width, row->height);
7371 else
7373 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7375 if (width < 0)
7376 width = row->height;
7378 width = min (row->height, width);
7380 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7381 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7383 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7384 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7385 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7386 row->height - width),
7387 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7390 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7395 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7397 static void
7398 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7400 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7401 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7402 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7403 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7407 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7409 static void
7410 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7412 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7413 x, y, width, height, False);
7414 #ifdef USE_GTK
7415 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7416 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7417 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7418 #endif
7422 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7424 static void
7425 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7427 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7429 if (on_p)
7431 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7432 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7434 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7435 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7436 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7437 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7439 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7440 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7442 else
7444 switch (cursor_type)
7446 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7447 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7448 break;
7450 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7451 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7452 break;
7454 case BAR_CURSOR:
7455 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7456 break;
7458 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7459 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7460 break;
7462 case NO_CURSOR:
7463 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7464 break;
7466 default:
7467 abort ();
7471 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7472 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7473 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7474 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7475 #endif
7478 #ifndef XFlush
7479 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7480 #endif
7484 /* Icons. */
7486 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7489 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7491 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7493 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7494 return 1;
7496 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7497 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7498 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7499 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7501 if (STRINGP (file))
7503 #ifdef USE_GTK
7504 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7505 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7506 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7507 return 0;
7508 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7509 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7510 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7512 else
7514 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7515 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7517 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7519 #ifdef USE_GTK
7521 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7522 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7523 return 0;
7525 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7527 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7528 if (rc != -1)
7529 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7531 #endif
7533 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7534 if (rc == -1)
7536 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7537 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7538 if (rc == -1)
7539 return 1;
7541 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7542 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7546 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7547 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7548 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7549 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7550 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7552 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7555 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7556 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7558 return 0;
7562 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7563 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7566 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7568 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7569 return 1;
7572 XTextProperty text;
7573 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7574 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7575 text.format = 8;
7576 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7577 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7580 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7581 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7582 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7583 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7585 return 0;
7588 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7590 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7591 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7593 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7594 be called from a signal handler.
7597 struct x_error_message_stack {
7598 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7599 Display *dpy;
7600 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7602 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7604 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7605 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7606 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7608 static void
7609 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7611 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7612 x_error_message->string,
7613 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7616 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7617 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7618 operating on.
7620 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7621 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7622 stored in *x_error_message.
7624 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7625 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7627 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7629 void
7630 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7632 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7634 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7635 XSync (dpy, False);
7637 data->dpy = dpy;
7638 data->string[0] = 0;
7639 data->prev = x_error_message;
7640 x_error_message = data;
7643 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7644 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7646 void
7647 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7649 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7651 BLOCK_INPUT;
7653 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7654 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7655 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7656 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7658 tmp = x_error_message;
7659 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7660 xfree (tmp);
7661 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7664 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7665 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7666 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7668 void
7669 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7671 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7672 XSync (dpy, False);
7674 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7676 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7677 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7678 x_uncatch_errors ();
7679 error (format, string);
7683 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7684 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7687 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7689 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7690 XSync (dpy, False);
7692 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7695 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7697 void
7698 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7700 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7703 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7704 * idea. --lorentey */
7705 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7707 void
7708 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7710 while (x_error_message)
7711 x_uncatch_errors ();
7713 #endif
7715 #if 0
7716 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7717 x_trace_wire (void)
7719 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7721 #endif /* ! 0 */
7724 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7725 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7726 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7727 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7728 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7730 static void
7731 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7732 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7734 #ifdef USG
7735 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7736 must reestablish each time */
7737 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7738 #endif /* USG */
7742 /************************************************************************
7743 Handling X errors
7744 ************************************************************************/
7746 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7748 static char *error_msg;
7750 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7751 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7753 static void
7754 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7756 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7757 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7758 int idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7760 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7761 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7762 handling_signal = 0;
7764 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7765 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7767 if (dpyinfo)
7769 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7770 frame on it. */
7771 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7772 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7775 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7776 that are on the dead display. */
7777 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7779 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7780 minibuf_frame
7781 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7782 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7783 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7784 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7785 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7786 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7789 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7790 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7791 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7792 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7793 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7794 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7796 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7797 trying to find a replacement. */
7798 KVAR (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame) = Qt;
7799 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7802 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7803 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7804 if (dpyinfo)
7806 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7807 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7808 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7809 #ifdef USE_GTK
7810 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7811 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7812 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7813 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7814 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7815 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7816 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7817 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7818 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7819 error_msg);
7820 abort ();
7821 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7823 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7824 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7826 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7827 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7828 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7829 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7830 abort ();
7833 Lisp_Object tmp;
7834 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7835 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7839 if (terminal_list == 0)
7841 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7842 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7843 /* NOTREACHED */
7846 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7847 #ifdef SIGIO
7848 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7849 #endif
7850 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7851 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7853 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7854 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7856 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7857 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7859 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7860 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7861 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7862 error ("%s", error_msg);
7865 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7866 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7867 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7869 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7870 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7872 static int
7873 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7875 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7876 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7877 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7878 && event->minor_code == 0)
7880 return 0;
7882 #endif
7884 if (x_error_message)
7885 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7886 else
7887 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7888 return 0;
7891 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7892 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7893 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7895 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7897 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7898 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7900 static void NO_INLINE
7901 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7903 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7905 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7906 or colors that are not defined. */
7908 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7909 return;
7911 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7912 original error handler. */
7914 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7915 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7916 buf, event->request_code);
7917 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7921 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7922 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7923 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7925 static int
7926 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7928 char buf[256];
7930 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7931 DisplayString (display));
7932 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7933 return 0;
7936 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7938 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7939 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7940 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7941 FONT-OBJECT. */
7943 Lisp_Object
7944 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7946 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7948 if (fontset < 0)
7949 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7950 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7951 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7952 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7953 do. */
7954 return font_object;
7956 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7957 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7958 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7959 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7960 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7962 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7964 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7965 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7967 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7968 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7969 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7971 else
7973 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7974 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7977 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7979 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7980 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7981 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7982 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7983 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7986 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7987 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7988 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7990 BLOCK_INPUT;
7991 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7992 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7994 #endif
7996 return font_object;
8000 /***********************************************************************
8001 X Input Methods
8002 ***********************************************************************/
8004 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8006 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8008 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8009 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8010 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8012 static void
8013 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8015 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8016 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8018 BLOCK_INPUT;
8020 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8021 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8023 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8024 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8026 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8027 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8031 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8032 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8033 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8034 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8037 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8039 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8040 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8041 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8042 #endif
8044 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8045 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8047 static void
8048 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8050 XIM xim;
8052 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8053 if (use_xim)
8055 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8056 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8057 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8058 emacs_class);
8059 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8061 if (xim)
8063 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8064 XIMCallback destroy;
8065 #endif
8067 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8068 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8070 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8071 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8072 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8073 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8074 #endif
8078 else
8079 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8080 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8084 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8086 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8087 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8088 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8089 when the callback was registered. */
8091 static void
8092 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8094 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8095 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8097 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8098 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8099 return;
8101 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8103 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8104 as they have no XIC. */
8105 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8107 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8109 BLOCK_INPUT;
8110 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8112 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8114 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8115 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8116 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8118 create_frame_xic (f);
8119 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8120 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8121 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8123 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8124 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8129 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8133 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8136 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8137 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8138 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8139 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8141 static void
8142 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8144 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8145 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8146 if (use_xim)
8148 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8149 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8150 ptrdiff_t len;
8152 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8153 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8154 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8155 len = strlen (resource_name);
8156 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8157 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8158 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8159 resource_name, emacs_class,
8160 xim_instantiate_callback,
8161 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8162 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8163 least, hence the configure test. */
8164 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8165 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8166 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8167 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8169 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8173 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8175 static void
8176 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8178 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8179 if (use_xim)
8181 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8182 if (dpyinfo->display)
8183 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8184 NULL, emacs_class,
8185 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8186 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8187 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8188 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8189 if (dpyinfo->display)
8190 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8191 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8192 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8194 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8197 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8201 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8202 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8204 static void
8205 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8207 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8209 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8210 is already for the top-left corner. */
8211 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8212 return;
8214 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8215 position that fits on the screen. */
8216 if (flags & XNegative)
8217 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8218 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8221 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8223 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8224 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8225 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8227 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8228 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8229 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8230 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8231 is right, though.
8233 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8234 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8236 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8237 #endif
8239 if (flags & YNegative)
8240 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8241 - height + f->top_pos;
8244 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8245 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8246 so the flags should correspond. */
8247 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8250 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8251 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8252 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8253 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8254 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8256 void
8257 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8259 int modified_top, modified_left;
8261 if (change_gravity > 0)
8263 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8264 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8266 f->top_pos = yoff;
8267 f->left_pos = xoff;
8268 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8269 if (xoff < 0)
8270 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8271 if (yoff < 0)
8272 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8273 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8275 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8277 BLOCK_INPUT;
8278 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8280 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8281 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8283 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8285 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8286 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8287 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8288 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8289 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8292 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8293 modified_left, modified_top);
8295 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8296 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8297 ? 1 : 0);
8299 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8300 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8301 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8302 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8303 of the frame.
8305 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8306 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8307 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8309 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8310 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8311 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8312 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8313 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8314 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8316 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8319 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8320 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8321 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8322 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8323 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8325 static int
8326 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8328 Atom actual_type;
8329 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8330 int i, rc, actual_format;
8331 Window wmcheck_window;
8332 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8333 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8334 long max_len = 65536;
8335 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8336 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8337 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8339 BLOCK_INPUT;
8341 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8342 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8343 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8344 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8345 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8346 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8348 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8350 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8351 x_uncatch_errors ();
8352 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8353 return 0;
8356 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8357 XFree (tmp_data);
8359 /* Check if window exists. */
8360 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8361 x_sync (f);
8362 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8364 x_uncatch_errors ();
8365 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8366 return 0;
8369 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8371 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8372 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8373 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8374 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8375 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8376 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8378 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8379 tmp_data = NULL;
8380 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8381 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8382 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8383 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8384 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8386 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8388 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8389 x_uncatch_errors ();
8390 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8391 return 0;
8394 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8395 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8396 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8399 rc = 0;
8401 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8402 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8404 x_uncatch_errors ();
8405 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8407 return rc;
8410 static void
8411 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8413 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8415 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8416 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8417 make_number (32),
8418 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8419 Fcons
8420 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8421 Fcons
8422 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8423 value != 0
8424 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8425 : Qnil)));
8428 void
8429 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8431 Lisp_Object frame;
8432 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8434 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8436 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8437 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8440 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8441 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8442 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8444 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8446 static int
8447 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8448 Window window,
8449 int *size_state,
8450 int *sticky)
8452 Atom actual_type;
8453 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8454 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8455 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8456 long max_len = 65536;
8457 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8458 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8459 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8461 *sticky = 0;
8462 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8464 BLOCK_INPUT;
8465 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8466 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8467 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8468 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8469 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8471 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8473 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8474 x_uncatch_errors ();
8475 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8476 return ! f->iconified;
8479 x_uncatch_errors ();
8481 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8483 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8484 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8486 is_hidden = 1;
8487 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8489 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8491 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8492 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8493 else
8494 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8496 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8498 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8499 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8500 else
8501 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8503 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8504 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8505 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8506 *sticky = 1;
8509 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8510 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8511 return ! is_hidden;
8514 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8516 static int
8517 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8519 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8520 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8521 int cur, dummy;
8523 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8525 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8526 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8527 if (!have_net_atom)
8528 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8530 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8532 Lisp_Object frame;
8534 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8536 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8537 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8538 are sent at once. */
8539 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8541 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8542 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8543 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8544 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8545 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8546 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8547 break;
8548 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8549 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8550 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8551 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8552 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8553 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8554 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8555 break;
8556 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8557 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8558 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8559 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8560 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8561 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8562 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8563 break;
8564 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8565 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8566 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8567 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8568 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8569 break;
8570 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8571 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8572 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8573 else
8574 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8575 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8578 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8582 return have_net_atom;
8585 static void
8586 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8588 if (f->async_visible)
8590 BLOCK_INPUT;
8591 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8592 x_sync (f);
8593 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8598 static int
8599 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8601 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8602 Lisp_Object lval;
8603 int sticky = 0;
8604 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8606 lval = Qnil;
8607 switch (value)
8609 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8610 lval = Qfullwidth;
8611 break;
8612 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8613 lval = Qfullheight;
8614 break;
8615 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8616 lval = Qfullboth;
8617 break;
8618 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8619 lval = Qmaximized;
8620 break;
8623 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8624 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8626 return not_hidden;
8629 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8630 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8631 static void
8632 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8634 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8635 return;
8637 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8638 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8640 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8641 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8642 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8644 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8646 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8647 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8649 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8651 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8652 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8653 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8654 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8655 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8656 break;
8657 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8658 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8659 break;
8660 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8661 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8664 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8665 width, height);
8669 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8670 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8671 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8672 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8673 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8674 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8675 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8677 static void
8678 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8680 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8682 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8683 window manager window around the frame. */
8685 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8687 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8689 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8691 int adjusted_left;
8692 int adjusted_top;
8694 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8695 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8696 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8698 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8700 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8701 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8703 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8704 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8706 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8708 else
8709 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8710 frame's position. */
8712 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8716 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8717 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8718 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8719 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8720 of an exact comparison. */
8722 static void
8723 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8725 int count = 0;
8727 while (count++ < 50)
8729 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8731 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8732 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8733 loop. */
8735 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8736 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8738 if (fuzzy)
8740 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8741 pixels. */
8743 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8744 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8745 return;
8747 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8748 return;
8751 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8752 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8754 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8758 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8759 void
8760 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8762 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8764 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8765 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8766 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8768 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8769 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8771 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8772 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8773 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8774 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8775 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8777 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8779 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8780 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8781 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8782 BLOCK_INPUT;
8783 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8785 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8786 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8788 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8789 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8791 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8792 break; /* Timeout */
8794 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8795 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8799 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8800 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8801 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8802 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8804 static void
8805 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8807 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8809 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8810 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8811 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8813 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8815 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8817 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8818 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8819 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8820 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8822 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8823 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8824 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8825 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8828 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8829 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8830 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8831 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8832 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8834 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8835 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8836 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8837 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8839 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8840 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8841 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8842 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8843 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8845 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8846 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8848 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8849 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8850 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8851 if (f->async_visible)
8852 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8853 else
8855 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8856 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8857 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8858 x_sync (f);
8863 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8864 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8865 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8866 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8868 void
8869 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8871 BLOCK_INPUT;
8873 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8875 int r, c;
8877 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8878 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8879 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8880 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8881 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8882 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8883 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8884 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8885 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8886 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8887 is however. */
8888 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8889 #endif
8890 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8891 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8892 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8893 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8894 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8895 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8896 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8899 #ifdef USE_GTK
8900 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8901 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8902 else
8903 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8904 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8906 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8908 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8910 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8911 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8913 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8914 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8915 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8916 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8917 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8919 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8922 /* Mouse warping. */
8924 void
8925 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8927 int pix_x, pix_y;
8929 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8930 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8932 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8933 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8935 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8936 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8938 BLOCK_INPUT;
8940 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8941 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8942 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8945 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8947 void
8948 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8950 BLOCK_INPUT;
8952 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8953 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8954 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8957 /* Raise frame F. */
8959 void
8960 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8962 BLOCK_INPUT;
8963 if (f->async_visible)
8964 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8966 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8967 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8970 /* Lower frame F. */
8972 static void
8973 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8975 if (f->async_visible)
8977 BLOCK_INPUT;
8978 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8979 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8980 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8984 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
8986 void
8987 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
8989 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
8990 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
8991 if (f->async_visible)
8992 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
8993 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
8996 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8998 void
8999 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
9001 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9002 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9004 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9005 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
9007 Lisp_Object frame;
9008 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9009 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9010 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
9011 make_number (32),
9012 Fcons (make_number (1),
9013 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
9014 Qnil)));
9018 static void
9019 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
9021 if (raise_flag)
9022 x_raise_frame (f);
9023 else
9024 x_lower_frame (f);
9027 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9029 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
9031 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9033 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
9035 static void
9036 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
9038 unsigned long data[2];
9039 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9041 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9042 data[1] = flags;
9044 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9045 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9046 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9048 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9050 static void
9051 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9052 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9054 XEvent event;
9056 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9057 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9058 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9059 event.xclient.format = 32;
9060 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9061 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9062 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9063 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9064 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9066 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9067 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9068 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9071 /* Change of visibility. */
9073 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9074 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9075 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9076 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9077 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9078 finishes with it. */
9080 void
9081 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9083 Lisp_Object type;
9084 int original_top, original_left;
9085 int retry_count = 2;
9087 retry:
9089 BLOCK_INPUT;
9091 type = x_icon_type (f);
9092 if (!NILP (type))
9093 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9095 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9097 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9098 call x_set_offset a second time
9099 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9100 before the window gets really visible. */
9101 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9102 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9103 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9104 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9106 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9108 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9109 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9110 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9111 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9112 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9113 else
9115 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9116 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9118 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9119 #ifdef USE_GTK
9120 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9121 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9122 #else
9123 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9124 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9125 else
9126 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9127 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9128 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9131 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9133 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9134 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9135 so that incoming events are handled. */
9137 Lisp_Object frame;
9138 int count;
9139 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9140 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9141 will set it when they are handled. */
9142 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9144 original_left = f->left_pos;
9145 original_top = f->top_pos;
9147 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9148 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9150 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9152 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9153 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9154 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9155 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9157 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9158 because the window manager may choose the position
9159 and we don't want to override it. */
9161 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9162 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9163 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9164 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9165 && previously_visible)
9167 Drawable rootw;
9168 int x, y;
9169 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9171 BLOCK_INPUT;
9173 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9174 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9175 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9176 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9177 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9178 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9179 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9180 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9181 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9183 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9184 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9185 original_left, original_top);
9187 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9190 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9192 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9193 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9194 MapNotify at all.. */
9195 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9196 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9198 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9199 x_sync (f);
9201 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9202 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9203 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9204 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9205 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9206 probably a bug. */
9207 if (input_polling_used ())
9209 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9210 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9211 handler reset it. */
9212 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9213 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9214 poll_for_input_1 ();
9215 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9218 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9219 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9222 /* 2000-09-28: In
9224 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9225 (iconify-frame f)
9226 (raise-frame f))
9228 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9229 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9230 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9231 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9233 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9234 goto retry;
9238 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9240 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9242 void
9243 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9245 Window window;
9247 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9248 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9250 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9251 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9252 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9254 BLOCK_INPUT;
9256 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9257 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9258 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9259 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9260 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9261 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9263 #ifdef USE_GTK
9264 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9265 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9266 else
9267 #else
9268 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9269 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9270 else
9271 #endif
9274 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9275 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9277 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9278 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9282 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9283 just by the event that we get from the server.
9284 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9285 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9286 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9287 f->visible = 0;
9288 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9289 f->async_visible = 0;
9290 f->async_iconified = 0;
9292 x_sync (f);
9294 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9297 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9299 void
9300 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9302 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9303 int result;
9304 #endif
9305 Lisp_Object type;
9307 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9308 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9309 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9311 if (f->async_iconified)
9312 return;
9314 BLOCK_INPUT;
9316 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9318 type = x_icon_type (f);
9319 if (!NILP (type))
9320 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9322 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9323 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9325 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9326 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9328 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9329 f->iconified = 1;
9330 f->visible = 1;
9331 f->async_iconified = 1;
9332 f->async_visible = 0;
9333 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9334 return;
9336 #endif
9338 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9340 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9342 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9343 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9344 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9345 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9346 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9347 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9348 so we have to record it here. */
9349 f->iconified = 1;
9350 f->visible = 1;
9351 f->async_iconified = 1;
9352 f->async_visible = 0;
9353 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9354 return;
9357 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9358 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9359 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9360 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9362 if (!result)
9363 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9365 f->async_iconified = 1;
9366 f->async_visible = 0;
9369 BLOCK_INPUT;
9370 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9371 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9372 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9374 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9375 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9376 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9377 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9378 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9379 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9381 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9382 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9384 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9385 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9387 XEvent msg;
9389 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9390 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9391 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9392 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9393 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9395 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9396 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9397 False,
9398 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9399 &msg))
9401 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9402 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9406 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9407 IconicState. */
9408 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9410 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9412 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9413 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9416 f->async_iconified = 1;
9417 f->async_visible = 0;
9419 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9420 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9421 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9425 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9427 void
9428 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9430 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9431 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9432 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9433 Lisp_Object bar;
9434 struct scroll_bar *b;
9435 #endif
9437 BLOCK_INPUT;
9439 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9440 commands to the X server. */
9441 if (dpyinfo->display)
9443 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9444 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9445 face. */
9446 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9447 free_frame_faces (f);
9449 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9450 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9452 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9453 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9454 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9455 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9456 toolkit scroll bars. */
9457 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9459 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9460 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9462 #endif
9464 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9465 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9466 free_frame_xic (f);
9467 #endif
9469 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9470 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9472 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9473 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9475 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9476 we are using a toolkit. */
9477 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9478 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9480 free_frame_menubar (f);
9481 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9483 #ifdef USE_GTK
9484 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9485 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9487 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9488 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9489 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9491 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9492 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9493 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9494 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9495 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9496 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9498 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9499 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9500 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9501 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9502 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9503 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9504 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9505 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9506 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9507 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9508 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9509 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9510 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9511 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9512 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9514 x_free_gcs (f);
9515 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9518 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9519 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9520 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9522 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9523 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9524 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9525 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9526 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9527 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9529 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9531 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9532 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9533 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9534 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9535 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9536 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9537 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9540 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9544 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9546 static void
9547 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9549 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9551 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9552 commands to the X server. */
9553 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9554 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9556 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9560 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9562 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9563 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9564 that the window now has.
9565 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9566 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9567 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9569 #ifndef USE_GTK
9570 void
9571 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9573 XSizeHints size_hints;
9574 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9576 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9577 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9579 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9580 return;
9582 #endif
9584 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9585 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9587 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9588 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9590 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9591 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9593 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9594 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9595 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9596 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9597 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9598 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9600 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9602 int base_width, base_height;
9603 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9605 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9606 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9608 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9610 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9611 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9612 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9613 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9614 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9616 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9617 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9618 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9620 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9621 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9622 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9623 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9624 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9627 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9628 if (flags)
9630 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9631 goto no_read;
9635 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9636 long supplied_return;
9637 int value;
9639 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9640 &supplied_return);
9642 if (flags)
9643 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9644 else
9646 if (value == 0)
9647 hints.flags = 0;
9648 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9649 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9650 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9651 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9652 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9653 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9654 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9655 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9659 no_read:
9661 #ifdef PWinGravity
9662 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9663 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9665 if (user_position)
9667 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9668 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9670 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9672 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9674 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9676 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9678 static void
9679 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9681 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9682 Arg al[1];
9684 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9685 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9686 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9687 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9689 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9690 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9692 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9693 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9696 static void
9697 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9699 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9701 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9702 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9703 #endif
9705 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9707 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9708 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9709 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9710 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9712 else
9714 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9715 pixmap. */
9716 return;
9720 #ifdef USE_GTK
9722 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9723 return;
9726 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9729 Arg al[1];
9730 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9731 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9732 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9733 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9736 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9738 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9739 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9741 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9744 void
9745 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9747 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9749 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9750 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9751 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9753 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9757 /***********************************************************************
9758 Fonts
9759 ***********************************************************************/
9761 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9763 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9764 font table. */
9766 static void
9767 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9769 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9770 if (font->driver->check)
9771 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9774 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9777 /***********************************************************************
9778 Initialization
9779 ***********************************************************************/
9781 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9782 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9783 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9784 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9786 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9787 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9788 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9790 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9791 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9792 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9793 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9794 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9795 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9796 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9799 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9801 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9803 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9805 static int x_initialized;
9807 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9808 the screen number from the server number. */
9809 static int
9810 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9812 int seen_colon = 0;
9813 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9814 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9815 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9817 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9818 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9819 length_until_period++;
9821 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9822 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9823 name1 += 4;
9824 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9825 name2 += 4;
9826 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9827 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9828 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9829 name1 += system_name_length;
9830 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9831 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9832 name2 += system_name_length;
9833 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9834 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9835 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9836 name1 += length_until_period;
9837 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9838 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9839 name2 += length_until_period;
9841 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9843 if (*name1 == ':')
9844 seen_colon = 1;
9845 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9846 return 1;
9848 return (seen_colon
9849 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9850 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9853 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9854 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9855 to 5. */
9856 static void
9857 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9859 int nr = 0;
9860 int off = 0;
9862 while (!(mask & 1))
9864 off++;
9865 mask >>= 1;
9868 while (mask & 1)
9870 nr++;
9871 mask >>= 1;
9874 *offset = off;
9875 *bits = nr;
9878 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9879 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9882 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9884 int dpy_ok = 1;
9885 Display *dpy;
9887 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9888 if (dpy)
9889 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9890 else
9891 dpy_ok = 0;
9892 return dpy_ok;
9895 #ifdef USE_GTK
9896 static void
9897 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9898 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9900 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9901 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9903 #endif
9905 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9906 the structure that describes the open display.
9907 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9909 struct x_display_info *
9910 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9912 int connection;
9913 Display *dpy;
9914 struct terminal *terminal;
9915 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9916 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9917 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9918 ptrdiff_t lim;
9920 BLOCK_INPUT;
9922 if (!x_initialized)
9924 x_initialize ();
9925 ++x_initialized;
9928 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9929 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9931 #ifdef USE_GTK
9933 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9934 int argc;
9935 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9936 char **argv2 = argv;
9937 guint id;
9939 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9941 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9943 else
9945 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9946 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9948 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9949 argv[argc] = 0;
9951 argc = 0;
9952 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9954 if (! NILP (display_name))
9956 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9957 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9960 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9961 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9963 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9965 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9966 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9968 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9969 putenv (fix_events);
9972 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9973 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9974 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9975 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9977 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9978 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9979 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9981 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9982 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9984 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9985 fixup_locale ();
9986 xg_initialize ();
9988 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9990 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9991 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9993 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9994 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9996 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9997 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9999 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10000 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
10002 #endif
10004 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10005 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10008 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10009 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10010 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10011 errors with X11R5:
10012 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10013 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10014 So let's not use it until R6. */
10015 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10016 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10017 #endif
10020 int argc = 0;
10021 char *argv[3];
10023 argv[0] = "";
10024 argc = 1;
10025 if (xrm_option)
10027 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10028 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10030 turn_on_atimers (0);
10031 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
10032 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10033 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10034 &argc, argv);
10035 turn_on_atimers (1);
10037 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10038 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10039 fixup_locale ();
10040 #endif
10043 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10044 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10045 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10046 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10047 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10049 /* Detect failure. */
10050 if (dpy == 0)
10052 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10053 return 0;
10056 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10058 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10059 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10060 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10062 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10065 struct x_display_info *share;
10066 Lisp_Object tail;
10068 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10069 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10070 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10071 SSDATA (display_name)))
10072 break;
10073 if (share)
10074 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10075 else
10077 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10078 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10079 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vwindow_system) = Qx;
10081 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10082 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10083 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10084 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10085 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10087 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10089 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10091 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10092 list of terminals. */
10093 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10094 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10095 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10096 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10098 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10099 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10100 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10101 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vsystem_key_alist)
10102 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10103 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10104 BLOCK_INPUT;
10105 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10106 terminal_list = terminal;
10107 UNGCPRO;
10110 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10111 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10112 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10113 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10114 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10116 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10119 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10120 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10121 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10123 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10124 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10125 x_display_name_list);
10126 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10128 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10130 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10131 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10132 strncpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10133 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10135 #if 0
10136 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10137 #endif /* ! 0 */
10139 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10140 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10141 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10142 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10143 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10144 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10145 + 2);
10146 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10147 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10149 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10150 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10152 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10153 #ifdef USE_GTK
10154 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10155 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10156 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10158 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10159 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10161 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10162 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10163 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10164 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10165 #else
10166 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10167 #endif
10168 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10169 all versions. */
10170 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10172 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10173 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10174 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10175 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10176 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10177 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10178 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10179 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10180 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10181 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10182 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10183 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10184 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10185 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10186 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10187 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10188 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10189 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10190 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10191 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10192 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10193 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10194 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10195 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10196 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10197 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10198 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10199 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10201 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10202 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10203 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10205 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10207 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10208 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10209 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10210 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10211 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10212 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10215 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10216 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10218 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10220 Lisp_Object value;
10221 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10222 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10223 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10224 Qnil, Qnil);
10225 if (STRINGP (value)
10226 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10227 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10228 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10231 else
10232 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10233 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10235 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10237 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10238 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10239 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10240 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10241 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10242 for example). */
10243 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10244 double d;
10245 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10246 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10248 #endif
10250 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10252 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10253 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10254 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10255 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10256 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10257 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10258 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10259 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10260 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10264 const struct
10266 const char *name;
10267 Atom *atom;
10268 } atom_refs[] = {
10269 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10270 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10271 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10272 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10273 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10274 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10275 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10276 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10277 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10278 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10279 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10280 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10281 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10282 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10283 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10284 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10285 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10286 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10287 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10288 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10289 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10290 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10291 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10292 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10293 /* For properties of font. */
10294 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10295 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10296 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10297 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10298 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10299 /* Ghostscript support. */
10300 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10301 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10302 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10303 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10304 /* EWMH */
10305 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10306 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10307 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10308 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10309 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10310 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10311 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10312 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10313 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10314 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10315 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10316 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10317 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10318 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10319 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10320 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10321 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10322 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10323 /* Session management */
10324 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10325 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10326 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10329 int i;
10330 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10331 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10332 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10333 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (sizeof (Atom) * total_atom_count);
10334 char **atom_names = xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count);
10335 char xsettings_atom_name[64];
10337 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10338 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10340 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10341 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name),
10342 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10343 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10345 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10346 False, atoms_return);
10348 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10349 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10351 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10352 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10354 xfree (atom_names);
10355 xfree (atoms_return);
10358 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10359 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10360 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10361 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10363 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10364 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10365 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10367 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10368 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10371 dpyinfo->gray
10372 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10373 gray_bitmap_bits,
10374 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10375 1, 0, 1);
10378 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10379 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10380 #endif
10382 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10384 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10385 if (connection != 0)
10386 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10388 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10389 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10390 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10392 #ifdef SIGIO
10393 if (interrupt_input)
10394 init_sigio (connection);
10395 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10397 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10399 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10400 Font font;
10402 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10403 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10404 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10405 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10406 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10407 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10408 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10409 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10410 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10411 abort ();
10412 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10413 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10414 x_uncatch_errors ();
10416 #endif
10418 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10419 for debugging X code. */
10421 Lisp_Object value;
10422 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10423 build_string ("synchronous"),
10424 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10425 Qnil, Qnil);
10426 if (STRINGP (value)
10427 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10428 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10429 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10433 Lisp_Object value;
10434 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10435 build_string ("useXIM"),
10436 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10437 Qnil, Qnil);
10438 #ifdef USE_XIM
10439 if (STRINGP (value)
10440 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10441 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10442 use_xim = 0;
10443 #else
10444 if (STRINGP (value)
10445 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10446 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10447 use_xim = 1;
10448 #endif
10451 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10452 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10453 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10454 tty. */
10455 if (terminal->id == 1)
10456 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10457 #endif
10459 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10461 return dpyinfo;
10464 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10465 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10467 static void
10468 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10470 struct terminal *t;
10472 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10473 X display. */
10474 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10475 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10477 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10478 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10479 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10480 x_session_close ();
10481 #endif
10482 delete_terminal (t);
10483 break;
10486 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10488 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10489 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10490 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10491 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10492 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10493 else
10495 Lisp_Object tail;
10497 tail = x_display_name_list;
10498 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10500 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10502 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10503 break;
10505 tail = XCDR (tail);
10509 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10510 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10512 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10513 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10514 else
10516 struct x_display_info *tail;
10518 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10519 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10520 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10523 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10524 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10525 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10526 xfree (dpyinfo);
10529 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10531 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10532 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10533 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10534 that slows us down. */
10536 static void
10537 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10539 BLOCK_INPUT;
10540 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10541 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10543 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10544 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10545 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10546 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10548 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10551 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10552 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10553 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10554 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10555 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10556 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10557 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10559 void
10560 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10562 BLOCK_INPUT;
10563 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10565 EMACS_TIME interval;
10567 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10568 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10569 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10571 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10574 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10577 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10579 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10581 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10583 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10584 x_produce_glyphs,
10585 x_write_glyphs,
10586 x_insert_glyphs,
10587 x_clear_end_of_line,
10588 x_scroll_run,
10589 x_after_update_window_line,
10590 x_update_window_begin,
10591 x_update_window_end,
10592 x_cursor_to,
10593 x_flush,
10594 #ifdef XFlush
10595 x_flush,
10596 #else
10597 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10598 #endif
10599 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10600 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10601 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10602 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10603 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10604 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10605 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10606 x_draw_glyph_string,
10607 x_define_frame_cursor,
10608 x_clear_frame_area,
10609 x_draw_window_cursor,
10610 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10611 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10615 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10616 void
10617 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10619 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10621 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10622 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10623 if (!terminal->name)
10624 return;
10626 BLOCK_INPUT;
10627 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10628 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10629 X display. */
10630 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10631 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10632 #endif
10634 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10635 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10636 if (dpyinfo->display)
10638 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10639 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10641 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10642 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10643 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10644 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10646 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10647 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10648 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10649 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10650 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10651 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10652 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10653 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10654 leaks in other situations. */
10655 #if 0
10656 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10657 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10658 #else
10659 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10660 #endif
10661 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10662 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10663 closing all the displays. */
10664 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10665 #endif
10667 #ifdef USE_GTK
10668 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10669 #else
10670 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10671 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10672 #else
10673 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10674 #endif
10675 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10678 /* Mark as dead. */
10679 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10680 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10681 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10684 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10685 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10687 static struct terminal *
10688 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10690 struct terminal *terminal;
10692 terminal = create_terminal ();
10694 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10695 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10696 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10698 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10700 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10701 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10702 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10703 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10704 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10705 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10706 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10707 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10708 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10709 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10710 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10711 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10712 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10713 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10714 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10715 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10716 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10717 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10718 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10719 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10721 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10722 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10724 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10725 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10726 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10727 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10728 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10729 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10730 off the bottom. */
10732 return terminal;
10735 void
10736 x_initialize (void)
10738 baud_rate = 19200;
10740 x_noop_count = 0;
10741 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10742 any_help_event_p = 0;
10743 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10745 #ifdef USE_GTK
10746 current_count = -1;
10747 #endif
10749 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10750 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10752 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10753 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10755 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10757 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10758 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10759 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10760 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10761 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10762 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10763 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10765 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10766 #endif
10768 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10769 #ifndef USE_GTK
10770 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10771 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10772 #endif
10773 #endif
10775 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10776 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10777 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10779 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10780 original error handler. */
10781 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10782 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10784 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10786 xgselect_initialize ();
10790 void
10791 syms_of_xterm (void)
10793 x_error_message = NULL;
10795 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10796 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10798 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10799 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10801 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10802 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10804 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10805 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10807 #ifdef USE_GTK
10808 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10809 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10811 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10812 #endif
10814 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10815 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10816 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10817 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10818 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10819 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10820 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10821 sizes. */);
10822 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10824 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10825 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10826 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10827 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10828 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10829 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10830 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10832 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10833 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10834 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10835 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10836 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10837 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10838 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10839 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10840 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10842 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10843 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10844 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10845 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10846 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10847 With MS Windows, the value is t. */);
10848 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10849 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10850 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10851 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10852 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10853 #elif USE_GTK
10854 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10855 #else
10856 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10857 #endif
10858 #else
10859 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10860 #endif
10862 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10863 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10865 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10866 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10867 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10868 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10869 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10870 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10871 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10872 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10873 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10875 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10876 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10877 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10878 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10879 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10880 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10882 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10883 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10884 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10885 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10886 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10887 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10889 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10890 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10891 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10892 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10893 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10894 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10896 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10897 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10898 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10899 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10900 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10901 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10903 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10904 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10905 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10906 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10907 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10908 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10911 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */